ETH Price: $2,475.82 (+1.84%)

Transaction Decoder

Block:
20532889 at Aug-15-2024 08:38:47 AM +UTC
Transaction Fee:
0.000278379536378318 ETH $0.69
Gas Used:
100,274 Gas / 2.776188607 Gwei

Emitted Events:

235 NFTPass.Transfer( from=[Receiver] ERC1967Proxy, to=[Sender] 0xc6996e84bb38a47ea81e439476616f125929f855, tokenId=5067 )
236 ERC1967Proxy.0x0f5bb82176feb1b5e747e28471aa92156a04d9f3ab9f45f28e2d704232b93f75( 0x0f5bb82176feb1b5e747e28471aa92156a04d9f3ab9f45f28e2d704232b93f75, 0x000000000000000000000000c6996e84bb38a47ea81e439476616f125929f855, 0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000a4c )
237 ERC1967Proxy.0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef( 0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef, 0x000000000000000000000000c6996e84bb38a47ea81e439476616f125929f855, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000, 0x0000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000a4c )

Account State Difference:

  Address   Before After State Difference Code
0x15022550...D963252B5
(Titan Builder)
14.226082870827285002 Eth14.226166396262014098 Eth0.000083525434729096
0xa186D739...855D59571
0xbe33BC4A...100bB46F7
0xc6996e84...25929f855
0.08918050447482498 Eth
Nonce: 574
0.088902124938446662 Eth
Nonce: 575
0.000278379536378318

Execution Trace

ERC1967Proxy.d2acd13d( )
  • NFTStaking.batchUnstake( tokens=[2636] )
    • ERC1967Proxy.94ac6f9e( )
    • NFTPass.ownerOf( tokenId=5067 ) => ( 0x150225502FB8A965aC3A986A641d13AD963252B5 )
    • NFTPass.transferFrom( from=0x150225502FB8A965aC3A986A641d13AD963252B5, to=0xc6996e84bb38a47eA81e439476616F125929f855, tokenId=5067 )
    • ERC1967Proxy.dc8e92ea( )
      File 1 of 5: ERC1967Proxy
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev ERC1822: Universal Upgradeable Proxy Standard (UUPS) documents a method for upgradeability through a simplified
       * proxy whose upgrades are fully controlled by the current implementation.
       */
      interface IERC1822Proxiable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns the storage slot that the proxiable contract assumes is being used to store the implementation
           * address.
           *
           * IMPORTANT: A proxy pointing at a proxiable contract should not be considered proxiable itself, because this risks
           * bricking a proxy that upgrades to it, by delegating to itself until out of gas. Thus it is critical that this
           * function revert if invoked through a proxy.
           */
          function proxiableUUID() external view returns (bytes32);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (proxy/ERC1967/ERC1967Proxy.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../Proxy.sol";
      import "./ERC1967Upgrade.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This contract implements an upgradeable proxy. It is upgradeable because calls are delegated to an
       * implementation address that can be changed. This address is stored in storage in the location specified by
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1967[EIP1967], so that it doesn't conflict with the storage layout of the
       * implementation behind the proxy.
       */
      contract ERC1967Proxy is Proxy, ERC1967Upgrade {
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the upgradeable proxy with an initial implementation specified by `_logic`.
           *
           * If `_data` is nonempty, it's used as data in a delegate call to `_logic`. This will typically be an encoded
           * function call, and allows initializing the storage of the proxy like a Solidity constructor.
           */
          constructor(address _logic, bytes memory _data) payable {
              _upgradeToAndCall(_logic, _data, false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current implementation address.
           */
          function _implementation() internal view virtual override returns (address impl) {
              return ERC1967Upgrade._getImplementation();
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (proxy/ERC1967/ERC1967Upgrade.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
      import "../beacon/IBeacon.sol";
      import "../../interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol";
      import "../../utils/Address.sol";
      import "../../utils/StorageSlot.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This abstract contract provides getters and event emitting update functions for
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1967[EIP1967] slots.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       *
       * @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow delegatecall
       */
      abstract contract ERC1967Upgrade {
          // This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.rollback" subtracted by 1
          bytes32 private constant _ROLLBACK_SLOT = 0x4910fdfa16fed3260ed0e7147f7cc6da11a60208b5b9406d12a635614ffd9143;
          /**
           * @dev Storage slot with the address of the current implementation.
           * This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.implementation" subtracted by 1, and is
           * validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the implementation is upgraded.
           */
          event Upgraded(address indexed implementation);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current implementation address.
           */
          function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 implementation slot.
           */
          function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) private {
              require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeTo(address newImplementation) internal {
              _setImplementation(newImplementation);
              emit Upgraded(newImplementation);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade with additional setup call.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeToAndCall(
              address newImplementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              _upgradeTo(newImplementation);
              if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
                  Address.functionDelegateCall(newImplementation, data);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade with security checks for UUPS proxies, and additional setup call.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeToAndCallUUPS(
              address newImplementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              // Upgrades from old implementations will perform a rollback test. This test requires the new
              // implementation to upgrade back to the old, non-ERC1822 compliant, implementation. Removing
              // this special case will break upgrade paths from old UUPS implementation to new ones.
              if (StorageSlot.getBooleanSlot(_ROLLBACK_SLOT).value) {
                  _setImplementation(newImplementation);
              } else {
                  try IERC1822Proxiable(newImplementation).proxiableUUID() returns (bytes32 slot) {
                      require(slot == _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT, "ERC1967Upgrade: unsupported proxiableUUID");
                  } catch {
                      revert("ERC1967Upgrade: new implementation is not UUPS");
                  }
                  _upgradeToAndCall(newImplementation, data, forceCall);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Storage slot with the admin of the contract.
           * This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.admin" subtracted by 1, and is
           * validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _ADMIN_SLOT = 0xb53127684a568b3173ae13b9f8a6016e243e63b6e8ee1178d6a717850b5d6103;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the admin account has changed.
           */
          event AdminChanged(address previousAdmin, address newAdmin);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current admin.
           */
          function _getAdmin() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 admin slot.
           */
          function _setAdmin(address newAdmin) private {
              require(newAdmin != address(0), "ERC1967: new admin is the zero address");
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value = newAdmin;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Changes the admin of the proxy.
           *
           * Emits an {AdminChanged} event.
           */
          function _changeAdmin(address newAdmin) internal {
              emit AdminChanged(_getAdmin(), newAdmin);
              _setAdmin(newAdmin);
          }
          /**
           * @dev The storage slot of the UpgradeableBeacon contract which defines the implementation for this proxy.
           * This is bytes32(uint256(keccak256('eip1967.proxy.beacon')) - 1)) and is validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _BEACON_SLOT = 0xa3f0ad74e5423aebfd80d3ef4346578335a9a72aeaee59ff6cb3582b35133d50;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the beacon is upgraded.
           */
          event BeaconUpgraded(address indexed beacon);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current beacon.
           */
          function _getBeacon() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new beacon in the EIP1967 beacon slot.
           */
          function _setBeacon(address newBeacon) private {
              require(Address.isContract(newBeacon), "ERC1967: new beacon is not a contract");
              require(
                  Address.isContract(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation()),
                  "ERC1967: beacon implementation is not a contract"
              );
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value = newBeacon;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform beacon upgrade with additional setup call. Note: This upgrades the address of the beacon, it does
           * not upgrade the implementation contained in the beacon (see {UpgradeableBeacon-_setImplementation} for that).
           *
           * Emits a {BeaconUpgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeBeaconToAndCall(
              address newBeacon,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              _setBeacon(newBeacon);
              emit BeaconUpgraded(newBeacon);
              if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
                  Address.functionDelegateCall(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation(), data);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (proxy/Proxy.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This abstract contract provides a fallback function that delegates all calls to another contract using the EVM
       * instruction `delegatecall`. We refer to the second contract as the _implementation_ behind the proxy, and it has to
       * be specified by overriding the virtual {_implementation} function.
       *
       * Additionally, delegation to the implementation can be triggered manually through the {_fallback} function, or to a
       * different contract through the {_delegate} function.
       *
       * The success and return data of the delegated call will be returned back to the caller of the proxy.
       */
      abstract contract Proxy {
          /**
           * @dev Delegates the current call to `implementation`.
           *
           * This function does not return to its internal call site, it will return directly to the external caller.
           */
          function _delegate(address implementation) internal virtual {
              assembly {
                  // Copy msg.data. We take full control of memory in this inline assembly
                  // block because it will not return to Solidity code. We overwrite the
                  // Solidity scratch pad at memory position 0.
                  calldatacopy(0, 0, calldatasize())
                  // Call the implementation.
                  // out and outsize are 0 because we don't know the size yet.
                  let result := delegatecall(gas(), implementation, 0, calldatasize(), 0, 0)
                  // Copy the returned data.
                  returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
                  switch result
                  // delegatecall returns 0 on error.
                  case 0 {
                      revert(0, returndatasize())
                  }
                  default {
                      return(0, returndatasize())
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev This is a virtual function that should be overridden so it returns the address to which the fallback function
           * and {_fallback} should delegate.
           */
          function _implementation() internal view virtual returns (address);
          /**
           * @dev Delegates the current call to the address returned by `_implementation()`.
           *
           * This function does not return to its internal call site, it will return directly to the external caller.
           */
          function _fallback() internal virtual {
              _beforeFallback();
              _delegate(_implementation());
          }
          /**
           * @dev Fallback function that delegates calls to the address returned by `_implementation()`. Will run if no other
           * function in the contract matches the call data.
           */
          fallback() external payable virtual {
              _fallback();
          }
          /**
           * @dev Fallback function that delegates calls to the address returned by `_implementation()`. Will run if call data
           * is empty.
           */
          receive() external payable virtual {
              _fallback();
          }
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called before falling back to the implementation. Can happen as part of a manual `_fallback`
           * call, or as part of the Solidity `fallback` or `receive` functions.
           *
           * If overridden should call `super._beforeFallback()`.
           */
          function _beforeFallback() internal virtual {}
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (proxy/beacon/IBeacon.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is the interface that {BeaconProxy} expects of its beacon.
       */
      interface IBeacon {
          /**
           * @dev Must return an address that can be used as a delegate call target.
           *
           * {BeaconProxy} will check that this address is a contract.
           */
          function implementation() external view returns (address);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library Address {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
                  if (returndata.length > 0) {
                      // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                          revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                      }
                  } else {
                      revert(errorMessage);
                  }
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/StorageSlot.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Library for reading and writing primitive types to specific storage slots.
       *
       * Storage slots are often used to avoid storage conflict when dealing with upgradeable contracts.
       * This library helps with reading and writing to such slots without the need for inline assembly.
       *
       * The functions in this library return Slot structs that contain a `value` member that can be used to read or write.
       *
       * Example usage to set ERC1967 implementation slot:
       * ```
       * contract ERC1967 {
       *     bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
       *
       *     function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
       *         return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
       *     }
       *
       *     function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) internal {
       *         require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
       *         StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
       *     }
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * _Available since v4.1 for `address`, `bool`, `bytes32`, and `uint256`._
       */
      library StorageSlot {
          struct AddressSlot {
              address value;
          }
          struct BooleanSlot {
              bool value;
          }
          struct Bytes32Slot {
              bytes32 value;
          }
          struct Uint256Slot {
              uint256 value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `AddressSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getAddressSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (AddressSlot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `BooleanSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getBooleanSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (BooleanSlot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `Bytes32Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getBytes32Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Bytes32Slot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `Uint256Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getUint256Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Uint256Slot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      

      File 2 of 5: NFTPass
      // Dependency file: erc721a/contracts/IERC721A.sol
      
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721A.
       */
      interface IERC721A {
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
      
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
      
          /**
           * Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
           */
          error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
      
          /**
           * Cannot mint to the zero address.
           */
          error MintToZeroAddress();
      
          /**
           * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
           */
          error MintZeroQuantity();
      
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
      
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
      
          /**
           * The token must be owned by `from`.
           */
          error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
      
          /**
           * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
           * ERC721Receiver interface.
           */
          error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
      
          /**
           * Cannot transfer to the zero address.
           */
          error TransferToZeroAddress();
      
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
      
          /**
           * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
           */
          error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
      
          /**
           * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
           */
          error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
      
          // =============================================================
          //                            STRUCTS
          // =============================================================
      
          struct TokenOwnership {
              // The address of the owner.
              address addr;
              // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
              uint64 startTimestamp;
              // Whether the token has been burned.
              bool burned;
              // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
              uint24 extraData;
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                         TOKEN COUNTERS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
      
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
      
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC721
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
      
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
      
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
           * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
      
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
           * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
           * to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
           * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external payable;
      
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external payable;
      
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
           * whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external payable;
      
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
      
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
      
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() external view returns (string memory);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
      
          // =============================================================
          //                           IERC2309
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
           * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
           *
           * See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
           */
          event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: erc721a/contracts/ERC721A.sol
      
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      
      // import '/Users/rico/workspace/blockchain/attic/node_modules/erc721a/contracts/IERC721A.sol';
      
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
       */
      interface ERC721A__IERC721Receiver {
          function onERC721Received(
              address operator,
              address from,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external returns (bytes4);
      }
      
      /**
       * @title ERC721A
       *
       * @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
       * Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
       * Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
       *
       * Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
       * starting from `_startTokenId()`.
       *
       * Assumptions:
       *
       * - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
       * - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
       */
      contract ERC721A is IERC721A {
          // Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
          struct TokenApprovalRef {
              address value;
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                           CONSTANTS
          // =============================================================
      
          // Mask of an entry in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
      
          // The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
      
          // The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
      
          // The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
      
          // Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
      
          // The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
      
          // The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
      
          // The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
      
          // The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
      
          // The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
      
          // Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
      
          // The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
      
          // The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
          // This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
          // For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
          // is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
          uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
      
          // The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
          // `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
          bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
              0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
      
          // =============================================================
          //                            STORAGE
          // =============================================================
      
          // The next token ID to be minted.
          uint256 private _currentIndex;
      
          // The number of tokens burned.
          uint256 private _burnCounter;
      
          // Token name
          string private _name;
      
          // Token symbol
          string private _symbol;
      
          // Mapping from token ID to ownership details
          // An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
          // See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
          //
          // Bits Layout:
          // - [0..159]   `addr`
          // - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
          // - [224]      `burned`
          // - [225]      `nextInitialized`
          // - [232..255] `extraData`
          mapping(uint256 => uint256) private _packedOwnerships;
      
          // Mapping owner address to address data.
          //
          // Bits Layout:
          // - [0..63]    `balance`
          // - [64..127]  `numberMinted`
          // - [128..191] `numberBurned`
          // - [192..255] `aux`
          mapping(address => uint256) private _packedAddressData;
      
          // Mapping from token ID to approved address.
          mapping(uint256 => TokenApprovalRef) private _tokenApprovals;
      
          // Mapping from owner to operator approvals
          mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
      
          // =============================================================
          //                          CONSTRUCTOR
          // =============================================================
      
          constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
              _name = name_;
              _symbol = symbol_;
              _currentIndex = _startTokenId();
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                   TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the starting token ID.
           * To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
           */
          function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return 0;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
           */
          function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return _currentIndex;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              // Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
              // more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
              unchecked {
                  return _currentIndex - _burnCounter - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
           */
          function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              // Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
              // and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
              unchecked {
                  return _currentIndex - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
           */
          function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return _burnCounter;
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                    ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              if (owner == address(0)) revert BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
              return _packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
      
          /**
           * Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
           */
          function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
              return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
      
          /**
           * Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
           */
          function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
              return (_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
      
          /**
           * Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
           */
          function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
              return uint64(_packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
          }
      
          /**
           * Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
           * If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
           */
          function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
              uint256 packed = _packedAddressData[owner];
              uint256 auxCasted;
              // Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
              assembly {
                  auxCasted := aux
              }
              packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
              _packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              // The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
              // of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
              // See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
              // (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
              return
                  interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
                  interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
                  interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return _name;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return _symbol;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
      
              string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
              return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : '';
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
           * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
           * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
           */
          function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
              return '';
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                     OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
           * It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
           */
          function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
              return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
           */
          function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
              return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnerships[index]);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
           */
          function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
              if (_packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
                  _packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
              }
          }
      
          /**
           * Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
           */
          function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256) {
              uint256 curr = tokenId;
      
              unchecked {
                  if (_startTokenId() <= curr)
                      if (curr < _currentIndex) {
                          uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[curr];
                          // If not burned.
                          if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) {
                              // Invariant:
                              // There will always be an initialized ownership slot
                              // (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
                              // before an unintialized ownership slot
                              // (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
                              // Hence, `curr` will not underflow.
                              //
                              // We can directly compare the packed value.
                              // If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
                              while (packed == 0) {
                                  packed = _packedOwnerships[--curr];
                              }
                              return packed;
                          }
                      }
              }
              revert OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
           */
          function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
              ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
              ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
              ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
              ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
           */
          function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
              assembly {
                  // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
                  result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
              }
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
           */
          function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
              // For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
              assembly {
                  // `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
                  result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
              }
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                      APPROVAL OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
              address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
      
              if (_msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
                  if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
                      revert ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
                  }
      
              _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
              emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              if (!_exists(tokenId)) revert ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
      
              return _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
              _operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
              emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
           *
           * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
           */
          function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
              return
                  _startTokenId() <= tokenId &&
                  tokenId < _currentIndex && // If within bounds,
                  _packedOwnerships[tokenId] & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0; // and not burned.
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
           */
          function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
              address approvedAddress,
              address owner,
              address msgSender
          ) private pure returns (bool result) {
              assembly {
                  // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
                  result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
              }
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
           */
          function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId)
              private
              view
              returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress)
          {
              TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
              // The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
              assembly {
                  approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
                  approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
              }
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                      TRANSFER OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) public payable virtual override {
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
      
              if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) revert TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
      
              (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
      
              // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
              if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
                  if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
      
              if (to == address(0)) revert TransferToZeroAddress();
      
              _beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
      
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner.
              assembly {
                  if approvedAddress {
                      // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
                      sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
                  }
              }
      
              // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
              // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
              // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
                  --_packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
                  ++_packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
      
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the next owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
                  _packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
                  );
      
                  // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
                  if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
                      uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
                      // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
                      if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
                          // If the next slot is within bounds.
                          if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
                              // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
                              _packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
                          }
                      }
                  }
              }
      
              emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
              _afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) public payable virtual override {
              safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory _data
          ) public payable virtual override {
              transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
              if (to.code.length != 0)
                  if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
                      revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
                  }
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
           * are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
           * And also called before burning one token.
           *
           * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
           * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _beforeTokenTransfers(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 startTokenId,
              uint256 quantity
          ) internal virtual {}
      
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
           * have been transferred. This includes minting.
           * And also called after one token has been burned.
           *
           * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
           * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _afterTokenTransfers(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 startTokenId,
              uint256 quantity
          ) internal virtual {}
      
          /**
           * @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
           *
           * `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
           * `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
           * `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
           * `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
           *
           * Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
           */
          function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory _data
          ) private returns (bool) {
              try ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data) returns (
                  bytes4 retval
              ) {
                  return retval == ERC721A__IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received.selector;
              } catch (bytes memory reason) {
                  if (reason.length == 0) {
                      revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
                  } else {
                      assembly {
                          revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
                      }
                  }
              }
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                        MINT OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
           */
          function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
              if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
      
              _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
      
              // Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
              // `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
              // `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance += quantity`.
                  // - `numberMinted += quantity`.
                  //
                  // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
                  _packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
      
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
                  _packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
                  );
      
                  uint256 toMasked;
                  uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
      
                  // Use assembly to loop and emit the `Transfer` event for gas savings.
                  // The duplicated `log4` removes an extra check and reduces stack juggling.
                  // The assembly, together with the surrounding Solidity code, have been
                  // delicately arranged to nudge the compiler into producing optimized opcodes.
                  assembly {
                      // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                      toMasked := and(to, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                      // Emit the `Transfer` event.
                      log4(
                          0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
                          0, // End of data (0, since no data).
                          _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
                          0, // `address(0)`.
                          toMasked, // `to`.
                          startTokenId // `tokenId`.
                      )
      
                      // The `iszero(eq(,))` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
                      // that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
                      // The compiler will optimize the `iszero` away for performance.
                      for {
                          let tokenId := add(startTokenId, 1)
                      } iszero(eq(tokenId, end)) {
                          tokenId := add(tokenId, 1)
                      } {
                          // Emit the `Transfer` event. Similar to above.
                          log4(0, 0, _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, 0, toMasked, tokenId)
                      }
                  }
                  if (toMasked == 0) revert MintToZeroAddress();
      
                  _currentIndex = end;
              }
              _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
           *
           * It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
           * instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
           *
           * Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
           * non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
           * For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
           * {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
           */
          function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              uint256 startTokenId = _currentIndex;
              if (to == address(0)) revert MintToZeroAddress();
              if (quantity == 0) revert MintZeroQuantity();
              if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) revert MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
      
              _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
      
              // Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance += quantity`.
                  // - `numberMinted += quantity`.
                  //
                  // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
                  _packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
      
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
                  _packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
                  );
      
                  emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
      
                  _currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
              }
              _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * See {_mint}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
           */
          function _safeMint(
              address to,
              uint256 quantity,
              bytes memory _data
          ) internal virtual {
              _mint(to, quantity);
      
              unchecked {
                  if (to.code.length != 0) {
                      uint256 end = _currentIndex;
                      uint256 index = end - quantity;
                      do {
                          if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
                              revert TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
                          }
                      } while (index < end);
                      // Reentrancy protection.
                      if (_currentIndex != end) revert();
                  }
              }
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
           */
          function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              _safeMint(to, quantity, '');
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                        BURN OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _burn(tokenId, false);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
      
              address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
      
              (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
      
              if (approvalCheck) {
                  // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
                  if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
                      if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) revert TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
              }
      
              _beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
      
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner.
              assembly {
                  if approvedAddress {
                      // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
                      sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
                  }
              }
      
              // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
              // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
              // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance -= 1`.
                  // - `numberBurned += 1`.
                  //
                  // We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
                  // This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
                  _packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
      
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the last owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
                  // - `burned` to `true`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
                  _packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      from,
                      (_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
                  );
      
                  // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
                  if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
                      uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
                      // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
                      if (_packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
                          // If the next slot is within bounds.
                          if (nextTokenId != _currentIndex) {
                              // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
                              _packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
                          }
                      }
                  }
              }
      
              emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
              _afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
      
              // Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
              unchecked {
                  _burnCounter++;
              }
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                     EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
           */
          function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
              uint256 packed = _packedOwnerships[index];
              if (packed == 0) revert OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
              uint256 extraDataCasted;
              // Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
              assembly {
                  extraDataCasted := extraData
              }
              packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
              _packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
           * Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
           *
           * `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _extraData(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint24 previousExtraData
          ) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
           * The returned result is shifted into position.
           */
          function _nextExtraData(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked
          ) private view returns (uint256) {
              uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
              return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
          }
      
          // =============================================================
          //                       OTHER OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
           *
           * If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
           */
          function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
           */
          function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
              assembly {
                  // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
                  // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
                  // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
                  // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
                  let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
                  // Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
                  mstore(0x40, m)
                  // Assign the `str` to the end.
                  str := sub(m, 0x20)
                  // Zeroize the slot after the string.
                  mstore(str, 0)
      
                  // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
                  let end := str
      
                  // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
                  // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
                  // prettier-ignore
                  for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
                      str := sub(str, 1)
                      // Write the character to the pointer.
                      // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
                      mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
                      // Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
                      temp := div(temp, 10)
                      // prettier-ignore
                      if iszero(temp) { break }
                  }
      
                  let length := sub(end, str)
                  // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
                  str := sub(str, 0x20)
                  // Store the length.
                  mstore(str, length)
              }
          }
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/IERC165.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
       *
       * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
       * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
       *
       * For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
       */
      interface IERC165 {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (token/ERC721/IERC721.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/IERC165.sol";
      
      /**
       * @dev Required interface of an ERC721 compliant contract.
       */
      interface IERC721 is IERC165 {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
      
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
      
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in ``owner``'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
      
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external;
      
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients
           * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must have been allowed to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external;
      
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom} whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external;
      
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external;
      
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom} for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      /**
       * @title ERC721 token receiver interface
       * @dev Interface for any contract that wants to support safeTransfers
       * from ERC721 asset contracts.
       */
      interface IERC721Receiver {
          /**
           * @dev Whenever an {IERC721} `tokenId` token is transferred to this contract via {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}
           * by `operator` from `from`, this function is called.
           *
           * It must return its Solidity selector to confirm the token transfer.
           * If any other value is returned or the interface is not implemented by the recipient, the transfer will be reverted.
           *
           * The selector can be obtained in Solidity with `IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector`.
           */
          function onERC721Received(
              address operator,
              address from,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external returns (bytes4);
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/extensions/IERC721Metadata.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/extensions/IERC721Metadata.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721.sol";
      
      /**
       * @title ERC-721 Non-Fungible Token Standard, optional metadata extension
       * @dev See https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721
       */
      interface IERC721Metadata is IERC721 {
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() external view returns (string memory);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library Address {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
      
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
      
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
      
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
      
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
      
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
                  if (returndata.length > 0) {
                      // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                          revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                      }
                  } else {
                      revert(errorMessage);
                  }
              }
          }
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Context.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      /**
       * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
       * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
       * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
       * manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
       * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
       * is concerned).
       *
       * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
       */
      abstract contract Context {
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
      
          function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
              return msg.data;
          }
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Strings.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Strings.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      /**
       * @dev String operations.
       */
      library Strings {
          bytes16 private constant _HEX_SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
          uint8 private constant _ADDRESS_LENGTH = 20;
      
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              // Inspired by OraclizeAPI's implementation - MIT licence
              // https://github.com/oraclize/ethereum-api/blob/b42146b063c7d6ee1358846c198246239e9360e8/oraclizeAPI_0.4.25.sol
      
              if (value == 0) {
                  return "0";
              }
              uint256 temp = value;
              uint256 digits;
              while (temp != 0) {
                  digits++;
                  temp /= 10;
              }
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(digits);
              while (value != 0) {
                  digits -= 1;
                  buffer[digits] = bytes1(uint8(48 + uint256(value % 10)));
                  value /= 10;
              }
              return string(buffer);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              if (value == 0) {
                  return "0x00";
              }
              uint256 temp = value;
              uint256 length = 0;
              while (temp != 0) {
                  length++;
                  temp >>= 8;
              }
              return toHexString(value, length);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
              buffer[0] = "0";
              buffer[1] = "x";
              for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
                  buffer[i] = _HEX_SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
                  value >>= 4;
              }
              require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
              return string(buffer);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Converts an `address` with fixed length of 20 bytes to its not checksummed ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(address addr) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return toHexString(uint256(uint160(addr)), _ADDRESS_LENGTH);
          }
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/ERC165.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/IERC165.sol";
      
      /**
       * @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
       *
       * Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
       * for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
       *
       * ```solidity
       * function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
       *     return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
       */
      abstract contract ERC165 is IERC165 {
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return interfaceId == type(IERC165).interfaceId;
          }
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/ERC721.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (token/ERC721/ERC721.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/extensions/IERC721Metadata.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Address.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Context.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Strings.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/ERC165.sol";
      
      /**
       * @dev Implementation of https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721[ERC721] Non-Fungible Token Standard, including
       * the Metadata extension, but not including the Enumerable extension, which is available separately as
       * {ERC721Enumerable}.
       */
      contract ERC721 is Context, ERC165, IERC721, IERC721Metadata {
          using Address for address;
          using Strings for uint256;
      
          // Token name
          string private _name;
      
          // Token symbol
          string private _symbol;
      
          // Mapping from token ID to owner address
          mapping(uint256 => address) private _owners;
      
          // Mapping owner address to token count
          mapping(address => uint256) private _balances;
      
          // Mapping from token ID to approved address
          mapping(uint256 => address) private _tokenApprovals;
      
          // Mapping from owner to operator approvals
          mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) private _operatorApprovals;
      
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the contract by setting a `name` and a `symbol` to the token collection.
           */
          constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) {
              _name = name_;
              _symbol = symbol_;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(ERC165, IERC165) returns (bool) {
              return
                  interfaceId == type(IERC721).interfaceId ||
                  interfaceId == type(IERC721Metadata).interfaceId ||
                  super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-balanceOf}.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              require(owner != address(0), "ERC721: address zero is not a valid owner");
              return _balances[owner];
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-ownerOf}.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              address owner = _owners[tokenId];
              require(owner != address(0), "ERC721: invalid token ID");
              return owner;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-name}.
           */
          function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return _name;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-symbol}.
           */
          function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return _symbol;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721Metadata-tokenURI}.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              _requireMinted(tokenId);
      
              string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
              return bytes(baseURI).length > 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, tokenId.toString())) : "";
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
           * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
           * by default, can be overridden in child contracts.
           */
          function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
              return "";
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-approve}.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public virtual override {
              address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId);
              require(to != owner, "ERC721: approval to current owner");
      
              require(
                  _msgSender() == owner || isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSender()),
                  "ERC721: approve caller is not token owner nor approved for all"
              );
      
              _approve(to, tokenId);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-getApproved}.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              _requireMinted(tokenId);
      
              return _tokenApprovals[tokenId];
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
              _setApprovalForAll(_msgSender(), operator, approved);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-isApprovedForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return _operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-transferFrom}.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) public virtual override {
              //solhint-disable-next-line max-line-length
              require(_isApprovedOrOwner(_msgSender(), tokenId), "ERC721: caller is not token owner nor approved");
      
              _transfer(from, to, tokenId);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) public virtual override {
              safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, "");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory data
          ) public virtual override {
              require(_isApprovedOrOwner(_msgSender(), tokenId), "ERC721: caller is not token owner nor approved");
              _safeTransfer(from, to, tokenId, data);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`, checking first that contract recipients
           * are aware of the ERC721 protocol to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * `data` is additional data, it has no specified format and it is sent in call to `to`.
           *
           * This internal function is equivalent to {safeTransferFrom}, and can be used to e.g.
           * implement alternative mechanisms to perform token transfer, such as signature-based.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _safeTransfer(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory data
          ) internal virtual {
              _transfer(from, to, tokenId);
              require(_checkOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, data), "ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
           *
           * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Tokens start existing when they are minted (`_mint`),
           * and stop existing when they are burned (`_burn`).
           */
          function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
              return _owners[tokenId] != address(0);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `spender` is allowed to manage `tokenId`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function _isApprovedOrOwner(address spender, uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
              address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId);
              return (spender == owner || isApprovedForAll(owner, spender) || getApproved(tokenId) == spender);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Safely mints `tokenId` and transfers it to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must not exist.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _safeMint(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _safeMint(to, tokenId, "");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-ERC721-_safeMint-address-uint256-}[`_safeMint`], with an additional `data` parameter which is
           * forwarded in {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} to contract recipients.
           */
          function _safeMint(
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory data
          ) internal virtual {
              _mint(to, tokenId);
              require(
                  _checkOnERC721Received(address(0), to, tokenId, data),
                  "ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer"
              );
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Mints `tokenId` and transfers it to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {_safeMint} whenever possible
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must not exist.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _mint(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              require(to != address(0), "ERC721: mint to the zero address");
              require(!_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: token already minted");
      
              _beforeTokenTransfer(address(0), to, tokenId);
      
              _balances[to] += 1;
              _owners[tokenId] = to;
      
              emit Transfer(address(0), to, tokenId);
      
              _afterTokenTransfer(address(0), to, tokenId);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              address owner = ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId);
      
              _beforeTokenTransfer(owner, address(0), tokenId);
      
              // Clear approvals
              _approve(address(0), tokenId);
      
              _balances[owner] -= 1;
              delete _owners[tokenId];
      
              emit Transfer(owner, address(0), tokenId);
      
              _afterTokenTransfer(owner, address(0), tokenId);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *  As opposed to {transferFrom}, this imposes no restrictions on msg.sender.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _transfer(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) internal virtual {
              require(ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId) == from, "ERC721: transfer from incorrect owner");
              require(to != address(0), "ERC721: transfer to the zero address");
      
              _beforeTokenTransfer(from, to, tokenId);
      
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner
              _approve(address(0), tokenId);
      
              _balances[from] -= 1;
              _balances[to] += 1;
              _owners[tokenId] = to;
      
              emit Transfer(from, to, tokenId);
      
              _afterTokenTransfer(from, to, tokenId);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Approve `to` to operate on `tokenId`
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _tokenApprovals[tokenId] = to;
              emit Approval(ERC721.ownerOf(tokenId), to, tokenId);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Approve `operator` to operate on all of `owner` tokens
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function _setApprovalForAll(
              address owner,
              address operator,
              bool approved
          ) internal virtual {
              require(owner != operator, "ERC721: approve to caller");
              _operatorApprovals[owner][operator] = approved;
              emit ApprovalForAll(owner, operator, approved);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Reverts if the `tokenId` has not been minted yet.
           */
          function _requireMinted(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual {
              require(_exists(tokenId), "ERC721: invalid token ID");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Internal function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target address.
           * The call is not executed if the target address is not a contract.
           *
           * @param from address representing the previous owner of the given token ID
           * @param to target address that will receive the tokens
           * @param tokenId uint256 ID of the token to be transferred
           * @param data bytes optional data to send along with the call
           * @return bool whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value
           */
          function _checkOnERC721Received(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory data
          ) private returns (bool) {
              if (to.isContract()) {
                  try IERC721Receiver(to).onERC721Received(_msgSender(), from, tokenId, data) returns (bytes4 retval) {
                      return retval == IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector;
                  } catch (bytes memory reason) {
                      if (reason.length == 0) {
                          revert("ERC721: transfer to non ERC721Receiver implementer");
                      } else {
                          /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                          assembly {
                              revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
                          }
                      }
                  }
              } else {
                  return true;
              }
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called before any token transfer. This includes minting
           * and burning.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, ``from``'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, ``from``'s `tokenId` will be burned.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           *
           * To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks].
           */
          function _beforeTokenTransfer(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) internal virtual {}
      
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called after any transfer of tokens. This includes
           * minting and burning.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - when `from` and `to` are both non-zero.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           *
           * To learn more about hooks, head to xref:ROOT:extending-contracts.adoc#using-hooks[Using Hooks].
           */
          function _afterTokenTransfer(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) internal virtual {}
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC1155/IERC1155.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (token/ERC1155/IERC1155.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/introspection/IERC165.sol";
      
      /**
       * @dev Required interface of an ERC1155 compliant contract, as defined in the
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1155[EIP].
       *
       * _Available since v3.1._
       */
      interface IERC1155 is IERC165 {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens of token type `id` are transferred from `from` to `to` by `operator`.
           */
          event TransferSingle(address indexed operator, address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 id, uint256 value);
      
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to multiple {TransferSingle} events, where `operator`, `from` and `to` are the same for all
           * transfers.
           */
          event TransferBatch(
              address indexed operator,
              address indexed from,
              address indexed to,
              uint256[] ids,
              uint256[] values
          );
      
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` grants or revokes permission to `operator` to transfer their tokens, according to
           * `approved`.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed account, address indexed operator, bool approved);
      
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the URI for token type `id` changes to `value`, if it is a non-programmatic URI.
           *
           * If an {URI} event was emitted for `id`, the standard
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1155#metadata-extensions[guarantees] that `value` will equal the value
           * returned by {IERC1155MetadataURI-uri}.
           */
          event URI(string value, uint256 indexed id);
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the amount of tokens of token type `id` owned by `account`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `account` cannot be the zero address.
           */
          function balanceOf(address account, uint256 id) external view returns (uint256);
      
          /**
           * @dev xref:ROOT:erc1155.adoc#batch-operations[Batched] version of {balanceOf}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `accounts` and `ids` must have the same length.
           */
          function balanceOfBatch(address[] calldata accounts, uint256[] calldata ids)
              external
              view
              returns (uint256[] memory);
      
          /**
           * @dev Grants or revokes permission to `operator` to transfer the caller's tokens, according to `approved`,
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `operator` cannot be the caller.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) external;
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `operator` is approved to transfer ``account``'s tokens.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address account, address operator) external view returns (bool);
      
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `amount` tokens of token type `id` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Emits a {TransferSingle} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must have been approved to spend ``from``'s tokens via {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - `from` must have a balance of tokens of type `id` of at least `amount`.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC1155Receiver-onERC1155Received} and return the
           * acceptance magic value.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 id,
              uint256 amount,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external;
      
          /**
           * @dev xref:ROOT:erc1155.adoc#batch-operations[Batched] version of {safeTransferFrom}.
           *
           * Emits a {TransferBatch} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `ids` and `amounts` must have the same length.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement {IERC1155Receiver-onERC1155BatchReceived} and return the
           * acceptance magic value.
           */
          function safeBatchTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256[] calldata ids,
              uint256[] calldata amounts,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external;
      }
      
      
      // Dependency file: @openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol
      
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
      
      // pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/utils/Context.sol";
      
      /**
       * @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
       * there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
       * specific functions.
       *
       * By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
       * can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
       *
       * This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
       * `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
       * the owner.
       */
      abstract contract Ownable is Context {
          address private _owner;
      
          event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
      
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
           */
          constructor() {
              _transferOwnership(_msgSender());
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
           */
          modifier onlyOwner() {
              _checkOwner();
              _;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
           */
          function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
              return _owner;
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
           */
          function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
              require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
           * `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
           *
           * NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
           * thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
           */
          function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
              _transferOwnership(address(0));
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
           * Can only be called by the current owner.
           */
          function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
              require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
              _transferOwnership(newOwner);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
           * Internal function without access restriction.
           */
          function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
              address oldOwner = _owner;
              _owner = newOwner;
              emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
          }
      }
      
      
      // Root file: contracts/core/token/NFTPass.sol
      
      pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
      
      // import "erc721a/contracts/ERC721A.sol";
      // import "erc721a/contracts/IERC721A.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/ERC721.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC1155/IERC1155.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/token/ERC721/IERC721.sol";
      // import "@openzeppelin/contracts/access/Ownable.sol";
      
      error NotWhiteListed();
      error InvalidPrice();
      error InvalidQuantity();
      error InvalidPassType();
      error FreeMintUsed();
      error WithdrawFailed();
      error MintingNotStarted();
      error MintingFinished();
      error OnlyOneFreeMintAllowed();
      
      contract NFTPass is ERC721A, Ownable {
      
          uint256 public constant MINT_START = 1666530000;
          event NFTWhiteListed(address indexed nft);
          event NFTPassPurchased(address indexed buyer, uint256 indexed quantity, uint256 price);
          event OwnerWithdrawn(uint256 amount);
          event OwnerMinting(uint256 quantity);
      
          enum NFTPassType { ERC721, ERC1155, ERC721A }
          // baseURI for the token metadata
          string public metadataURI;
          // whitelist for early adopter passes
          mapping(address => bool) public eapWhitelist ;
          uint256 public price = 0.03 ether;
      
          // for any whitelist wallet address, max number of passes they can mint is 1
          mapping(address => bool) public whitelistMinted;
      
          constructor(string memory name_, string memory symbol_, string memory baseUrl_) ERC721A(name_, symbol_) {
              metadataURI = baseUrl_;
              // Genesis Critterz
              eapWhitelist[0x8ffb9b504d497e4000967391e70D542b8cC6748A] = true;
              // Staked Critterz
              eapWhitelist[0x47f75E8dD28dF8d6E7c39ccda47026b0DCa99043] = true;
              // Critterz Plots
              eapWhitelist[0x3D7F0F28e1d42082e3de70ec4c9d1D59a07AFFb9] = true;
              // Staked Plot
              eapWhitelist[0xB81Cf242671eDAE57754B1a061F62Af08B32926A] = true;
              // CryptoMaids
              eapWhitelist[0x5703A3245FF6FAD37fa2a2500F0739d4F6a234E7] = true;
              // Mimic Shhans - THE SHHAN
              eapWhitelist[0xF75FD01D2262b07D92dcA7f19bD6A3457060d7db] = true;
              // Astro Baby Club
              eapWhitelist[0x6D5213b085d472273b625857ae0a11ecf2ce7f37] = true;
          }
      
          function contractURI() public pure returns (string memory) {
              return "https://metadata.atticc.xyz/my-metadata";
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
           * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
           * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
           */
          function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return metadataURI;
          }
      
          function _startTokenId() internal view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              return 1;
          }
      
          function checkNFTWhitelist(address nftAddress) public view returns (bool) {
              return eapWhitelist[nftAddress];
          }
      
          function checkUserMinted(address wallet) public view returns (bool) {
              return whitelistMinted[wallet];
          }
      
          function _checkHolder721(address nftAddress, address wallet) private view returns (bool)  {
              return IERC721(nftAddress).balanceOf(wallet) > 0;
          }
      
          function _checkHolder1155(address nftAddress, uint256 tokenId, address wallet) private view returns (bool) { 
              return IERC1155(nftAddress).balanceOf(wallet, tokenId) > 0;
          }
      
          function _checkHolder721A(address nftAddress, address wallet) private view returns (bool) { 
              return IERC721A(nftAddress).balanceOf(wallet) > 0;
          }
      
          function _mintingStarted() private view returns (bool) {
              return block.timestamp >= MINT_START;
          }
      
          function checkWhitelist(address nftPass, uint256 tokenId, NFTPassType passType) public view returns (bool) {
              if (!checkNFTWhitelist(nftPass)) {
                  return false;
              }
              if (passType == NFTPassType.ERC721) {
                  return _checkHolder721(nftPass, msg.sender);
              } else if (passType == NFTPassType.ERC1155) {
                  return _checkHolder1155(nftPass, tokenId, msg.sender);
              } else if (passType == NFTPassType.ERC721A) {
                  return _checkHolder721A(nftPass, msg.sender);
              } 
              revert InvalidPassType();
          }
      
          function setPrice(uint256 newPrice) external onlyOwner {
              price = newPrice;
          }
      
          function inviteCommunity(address communityAddr) external onlyOwner {
             eapWhitelist[communityAddr] = true;
          }
      
          function withdraw() external onlyOwner {
              uint256 balance = address(this).balance;
              (bool success, ) = owner().call{value: balance}("");
              if (!success) revert WithdrawFailed();
              emit OwnerWithdrawn(balance);
          }
      
          /**
           * @dev Mints NFTPasses for the given wallet address and transfer to the sender
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `quantity is required if it mints multiple tokens`.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function mint(address nftPass, uint256 tokenId, NFTPassType passType, uint256 quantity) external payable {
              if (totalSupply() + quantity > 5555) {
                  revert MintingFinished();
              }
              // `_mint`'s second argument now takes in a `quantity`, not a `tokenId`.
              // if (!_mintingStarted()) revert MintingNotStarted();
              bool isWhitelisted;
              if (msg.sender == owner()) {
                  emit OwnerMinting(quantity);
              } else if ( price > 0 ether && msg.value >= price * quantity) {
                  // this is a purchase of a pass
                  emit NFTPassPurchased(msg.sender, quantity, msg.value);
              } else {
                  // // every whitelisted user can only do one free mint
                  if (quantity > 1) {
                      revert InvalidQuantity();
                  }
                  // check if the user has already minted a pass for free
                  if (checkUserMinted(msg.sender)) {
                      revert OnlyOneFreeMintAllowed();
                  }
                  // check the nft that user holds is whitelisted
                  if (!checkWhitelist(nftPass, tokenId, passType)) {
                      revert NotWhiteListed();
                  }
                  isWhitelisted = true;
              }
              _mint(msg.sender, quantity);
              if (isWhitelisted) {
                  whitelistMinted[msg.sender] = true;
              }
          }
      }

      File 3 of 5: ERC1967Proxy
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev ERC1822: Universal Upgradeable Proxy Standard (UUPS) documents a method for upgradeability through a simplified
       * proxy whose upgrades are fully controlled by the current implementation.
       */
      interface IERC1822Proxiable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns the storage slot that the proxiable contract assumes is being used to store the implementation
           * address.
           *
           * IMPORTANT: A proxy pointing at a proxiable contract should not be considered proxiable itself, because this risks
           * bricking a proxy that upgrades to it, by delegating to itself until out of gas. Thus it is critical that this
           * function revert if invoked through a proxy.
           */
          function proxiableUUID() external view returns (bytes32);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (proxy/ERC1967/ERC1967Proxy.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../Proxy.sol";
      import "./ERC1967Upgrade.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This contract implements an upgradeable proxy. It is upgradeable because calls are delegated to an
       * implementation address that can be changed. This address is stored in storage in the location specified by
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1967[EIP1967], so that it doesn't conflict with the storage layout of the
       * implementation behind the proxy.
       */
      contract ERC1967Proxy is Proxy, ERC1967Upgrade {
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the upgradeable proxy with an initial implementation specified by `_logic`.
           *
           * If `_data` is nonempty, it's used as data in a delegate call to `_logic`. This will typically be an encoded
           * function call, and allows initializing the storage of the proxy like a Solidity constructor.
           */
          constructor(address _logic, bytes memory _data) payable {
              _upgradeToAndCall(_logic, _data, false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current implementation address.
           */
          function _implementation() internal view virtual override returns (address impl) {
              return ERC1967Upgrade._getImplementation();
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (proxy/ERC1967/ERC1967Upgrade.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
      import "../beacon/IBeacon.sol";
      import "../../interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol";
      import "../../utils/Address.sol";
      import "../../utils/StorageSlot.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This abstract contract provides getters and event emitting update functions for
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1967[EIP1967] slots.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       *
       * @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow delegatecall
       */
      abstract contract ERC1967Upgrade {
          // This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.rollback" subtracted by 1
          bytes32 private constant _ROLLBACK_SLOT = 0x4910fdfa16fed3260ed0e7147f7cc6da11a60208b5b9406d12a635614ffd9143;
          /**
           * @dev Storage slot with the address of the current implementation.
           * This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.implementation" subtracted by 1, and is
           * validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the implementation is upgraded.
           */
          event Upgraded(address indexed implementation);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current implementation address.
           */
          function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 implementation slot.
           */
          function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) private {
              require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeTo(address newImplementation) internal {
              _setImplementation(newImplementation);
              emit Upgraded(newImplementation);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade with additional setup call.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeToAndCall(
              address newImplementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              _upgradeTo(newImplementation);
              if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
                  Address.functionDelegateCall(newImplementation, data);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade with security checks for UUPS proxies, and additional setup call.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeToAndCallUUPS(
              address newImplementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              // Upgrades from old implementations will perform a rollback test. This test requires the new
              // implementation to upgrade back to the old, non-ERC1822 compliant, implementation. Removing
              // this special case will break upgrade paths from old UUPS implementation to new ones.
              if (StorageSlot.getBooleanSlot(_ROLLBACK_SLOT).value) {
                  _setImplementation(newImplementation);
              } else {
                  try IERC1822Proxiable(newImplementation).proxiableUUID() returns (bytes32 slot) {
                      require(slot == _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT, "ERC1967Upgrade: unsupported proxiableUUID");
                  } catch {
                      revert("ERC1967Upgrade: new implementation is not UUPS");
                  }
                  _upgradeToAndCall(newImplementation, data, forceCall);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Storage slot with the admin of the contract.
           * This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.admin" subtracted by 1, and is
           * validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _ADMIN_SLOT = 0xb53127684a568b3173ae13b9f8a6016e243e63b6e8ee1178d6a717850b5d6103;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the admin account has changed.
           */
          event AdminChanged(address previousAdmin, address newAdmin);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current admin.
           */
          function _getAdmin() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 admin slot.
           */
          function _setAdmin(address newAdmin) private {
              require(newAdmin != address(0), "ERC1967: new admin is the zero address");
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value = newAdmin;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Changes the admin of the proxy.
           *
           * Emits an {AdminChanged} event.
           */
          function _changeAdmin(address newAdmin) internal {
              emit AdminChanged(_getAdmin(), newAdmin);
              _setAdmin(newAdmin);
          }
          /**
           * @dev The storage slot of the UpgradeableBeacon contract which defines the implementation for this proxy.
           * This is bytes32(uint256(keccak256('eip1967.proxy.beacon')) - 1)) and is validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _BEACON_SLOT = 0xa3f0ad74e5423aebfd80d3ef4346578335a9a72aeaee59ff6cb3582b35133d50;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the beacon is upgraded.
           */
          event BeaconUpgraded(address indexed beacon);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current beacon.
           */
          function _getBeacon() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new beacon in the EIP1967 beacon slot.
           */
          function _setBeacon(address newBeacon) private {
              require(Address.isContract(newBeacon), "ERC1967: new beacon is not a contract");
              require(
                  Address.isContract(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation()),
                  "ERC1967: beacon implementation is not a contract"
              );
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value = newBeacon;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform beacon upgrade with additional setup call. Note: This upgrades the address of the beacon, it does
           * not upgrade the implementation contained in the beacon (see {UpgradeableBeacon-_setImplementation} for that).
           *
           * Emits a {BeaconUpgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeBeaconToAndCall(
              address newBeacon,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              _setBeacon(newBeacon);
              emit BeaconUpgraded(newBeacon);
              if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
                  Address.functionDelegateCall(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation(), data);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (proxy/Proxy.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This abstract contract provides a fallback function that delegates all calls to another contract using the EVM
       * instruction `delegatecall`. We refer to the second contract as the _implementation_ behind the proxy, and it has to
       * be specified by overriding the virtual {_implementation} function.
       *
       * Additionally, delegation to the implementation can be triggered manually through the {_fallback} function, or to a
       * different contract through the {_delegate} function.
       *
       * The success and return data of the delegated call will be returned back to the caller of the proxy.
       */
      abstract contract Proxy {
          /**
           * @dev Delegates the current call to `implementation`.
           *
           * This function does not return to its internal call site, it will return directly to the external caller.
           */
          function _delegate(address implementation) internal virtual {
              assembly {
                  // Copy msg.data. We take full control of memory in this inline assembly
                  // block because it will not return to Solidity code. We overwrite the
                  // Solidity scratch pad at memory position 0.
                  calldatacopy(0, 0, calldatasize())
                  // Call the implementation.
                  // out and outsize are 0 because we don't know the size yet.
                  let result := delegatecall(gas(), implementation, 0, calldatasize(), 0, 0)
                  // Copy the returned data.
                  returndatacopy(0, 0, returndatasize())
                  switch result
                  // delegatecall returns 0 on error.
                  case 0 {
                      revert(0, returndatasize())
                  }
                  default {
                      return(0, returndatasize())
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev This is a virtual function that should be overridden so it returns the address to which the fallback function
           * and {_fallback} should delegate.
           */
          function _implementation() internal view virtual returns (address);
          /**
           * @dev Delegates the current call to the address returned by `_implementation()`.
           *
           * This function does not return to its internal call site, it will return directly to the external caller.
           */
          function _fallback() internal virtual {
              _beforeFallback();
              _delegate(_implementation());
          }
          /**
           * @dev Fallback function that delegates calls to the address returned by `_implementation()`. Will run if no other
           * function in the contract matches the call data.
           */
          fallback() external payable virtual {
              _fallback();
          }
          /**
           * @dev Fallback function that delegates calls to the address returned by `_implementation()`. Will run if call data
           * is empty.
           */
          receive() external payable virtual {
              _fallback();
          }
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called before falling back to the implementation. Can happen as part of a manual `_fallback`
           * call, or as part of the Solidity `fallback` or `receive` functions.
           *
           * If overridden should call `super._beforeFallback()`.
           */
          function _beforeFallback() internal virtual {}
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (proxy/beacon/IBeacon.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is the interface that {BeaconProxy} expects of its beacon.
       */
      interface IBeacon {
          /**
           * @dev Must return an address that can be used as a delegate call target.
           *
           * {BeaconProxy} will check that this address is a contract.
           */
          function implementation() external view returns (address);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library Address {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
                  if (returndata.length > 0) {
                      // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                          revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                      }
                  } else {
                      revert(errorMessage);
                  }
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/StorageSlot.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Library for reading and writing primitive types to specific storage slots.
       *
       * Storage slots are often used to avoid storage conflict when dealing with upgradeable contracts.
       * This library helps with reading and writing to such slots without the need for inline assembly.
       *
       * The functions in this library return Slot structs that contain a `value` member that can be used to read or write.
       *
       * Example usage to set ERC1967 implementation slot:
       * ```
       * contract ERC1967 {
       *     bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
       *
       *     function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
       *         return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
       *     }
       *
       *     function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) internal {
       *         require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
       *         StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
       *     }
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * _Available since v4.1 for `address`, `bool`, `bytes32`, and `uint256`._
       */
      library StorageSlot {
          struct AddressSlot {
              address value;
          }
          struct BooleanSlot {
              bool value;
          }
          struct Bytes32Slot {
              bytes32 value;
          }
          struct Uint256Slot {
              uint256 value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `AddressSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getAddressSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (AddressSlot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `BooleanSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getBooleanSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (BooleanSlot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `Bytes32Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getBytes32Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Bytes32Slot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `Uint256Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getUint256Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Uint256Slot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      

      File 4 of 5: NFTStaking
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721A.
       */
      interface IERC721A {
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
           */
          error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
          /**
           * Cannot mint to the zero address.
           */
          error MintToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
           */
          error MintZeroQuantity();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token must be owned by `from`.
           */
          error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
          /**
           * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
           * ERC721Receiver interface.
           */
          error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
          /**
           * Cannot transfer to the zero address.
           */
          error TransferToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
           */
          error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
          /**
           * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
           */
          error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
          // =============================================================
          //                            STRUCTS
          // =============================================================
          struct TokenOwnership {
              // The address of the owner.
              address addr;
              // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
              uint64 startTimestamp;
              // Whether the token has been burned.
              bool burned;
              // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
              uint24 extraData;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                         TOKEN COUNTERS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC721
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
           * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
           * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
           * to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
           * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
           * whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
          // =============================================================
          //                           IERC2309
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
           * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
           *
           * See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
           */
          event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev ERC1822: Universal Upgradeable Proxy Standard (UUPS) documents a method for upgradeability through a simplified
       * proxy whose upgrades are fully controlled by the current implementation.
       */
      interface IERC1822Proxiable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns the storage slot that the proxiable contract assumes is being used to store the implementation
           * address.
           *
           * IMPORTANT: A proxy pointing at a proxiable contract should not be considered proxiable itself, because this risks
           * bricking a proxy that upgrades to it, by delegating to itself until out of gas. Thus it is critical that this
           * function revert if invoked through a proxy.
           */
          function proxiableUUID() external view returns (bytes32);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (proxy/ERC1967/ERC1967Upgrade.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
      import "../beacon/IBeacon.sol";
      import "../../interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol";
      import "../../utils/Address.sol";
      import "../../utils/StorageSlot.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This abstract contract provides getters and event emitting update functions for
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1967[EIP1967] slots.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       *
       * @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow delegatecall
       */
      abstract contract ERC1967Upgrade {
          // This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.rollback" subtracted by 1
          bytes32 private constant _ROLLBACK_SLOT = 0x4910fdfa16fed3260ed0e7147f7cc6da11a60208b5b9406d12a635614ffd9143;
          /**
           * @dev Storage slot with the address of the current implementation.
           * This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.implementation" subtracted by 1, and is
           * validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the implementation is upgraded.
           */
          event Upgraded(address indexed implementation);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current implementation address.
           */
          function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 implementation slot.
           */
          function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) private {
              require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeTo(address newImplementation) internal {
              _setImplementation(newImplementation);
              emit Upgraded(newImplementation);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade with additional setup call.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeToAndCall(
              address newImplementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              _upgradeTo(newImplementation);
              if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
                  Address.functionDelegateCall(newImplementation, data);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade with security checks for UUPS proxies, and additional setup call.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeToAndCallUUPS(
              address newImplementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              // Upgrades from old implementations will perform a rollback test. This test requires the new
              // implementation to upgrade back to the old, non-ERC1822 compliant, implementation. Removing
              // this special case will break upgrade paths from old UUPS implementation to new ones.
              if (StorageSlot.getBooleanSlot(_ROLLBACK_SLOT).value) {
                  _setImplementation(newImplementation);
              } else {
                  try IERC1822Proxiable(newImplementation).proxiableUUID() returns (bytes32 slot) {
                      require(slot == _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT, "ERC1967Upgrade: unsupported proxiableUUID");
                  } catch {
                      revert("ERC1967Upgrade: new implementation is not UUPS");
                  }
                  _upgradeToAndCall(newImplementation, data, forceCall);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Storage slot with the admin of the contract.
           * This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.admin" subtracted by 1, and is
           * validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _ADMIN_SLOT = 0xb53127684a568b3173ae13b9f8a6016e243e63b6e8ee1178d6a717850b5d6103;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the admin account has changed.
           */
          event AdminChanged(address previousAdmin, address newAdmin);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current admin.
           */
          function _getAdmin() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 admin slot.
           */
          function _setAdmin(address newAdmin) private {
              require(newAdmin != address(0), "ERC1967: new admin is the zero address");
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value = newAdmin;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Changes the admin of the proxy.
           *
           * Emits an {AdminChanged} event.
           */
          function _changeAdmin(address newAdmin) internal {
              emit AdminChanged(_getAdmin(), newAdmin);
              _setAdmin(newAdmin);
          }
          /**
           * @dev The storage slot of the UpgradeableBeacon contract which defines the implementation for this proxy.
           * This is bytes32(uint256(keccak256('eip1967.proxy.beacon')) - 1)) and is validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _BEACON_SLOT = 0xa3f0ad74e5423aebfd80d3ef4346578335a9a72aeaee59ff6cb3582b35133d50;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the beacon is upgraded.
           */
          event BeaconUpgraded(address indexed beacon);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current beacon.
           */
          function _getBeacon() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new beacon in the EIP1967 beacon slot.
           */
          function _setBeacon(address newBeacon) private {
              require(Address.isContract(newBeacon), "ERC1967: new beacon is not a contract");
              require(
                  Address.isContract(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation()),
                  "ERC1967: beacon implementation is not a contract"
              );
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value = newBeacon;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform beacon upgrade with additional setup call. Note: This upgrades the address of the beacon, it does
           * not upgrade the implementation contained in the beacon (see {UpgradeableBeacon-_setImplementation} for that).
           *
           * Emits a {BeaconUpgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeBeaconToAndCall(
              address newBeacon,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              _setBeacon(newBeacon);
              emit BeaconUpgraded(newBeacon);
              if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
                  Address.functionDelegateCall(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation(), data);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (proxy/beacon/IBeacon.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is the interface that {BeaconProxy} expects of its beacon.
       */
      interface IBeacon {
          /**
           * @dev Must return an address that can be used as a delegate call target.
           *
           * {BeaconProxy} will check that this address is a contract.
           */
          function implementation() external view returns (address);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (proxy/utils/UUPSUpgradeable.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../../interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol";
      import "../ERC1967/ERC1967Upgrade.sol";
      /**
       * @dev An upgradeability mechanism designed for UUPS proxies. The functions included here can perform an upgrade of an
       * {ERC1967Proxy}, when this contract is set as the implementation behind such a proxy.
       *
       * A security mechanism ensures that an upgrade does not turn off upgradeability accidentally, although this risk is
       * reinstated if the upgrade retains upgradeability but removes the security mechanism, e.g. by replacing
       * `UUPSUpgradeable` with a custom implementation of upgrades.
       *
       * The {_authorizeUpgrade} function must be overridden to include access restriction to the upgrade mechanism.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       */
      abstract contract UUPSUpgradeable is IERC1822Proxiable, ERC1967Upgrade {
          /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow state-variable-immutable state-variable-assignment
          address private immutable __self = address(this);
          /**
           * @dev Check that the execution is being performed through a delegatecall call and that the execution context is
           * a proxy contract with an implementation (as defined in ERC1967) pointing to self. This should only be the case
           * for UUPS and transparent proxies that are using the current contract as their implementation. Execution of a
           * function through ERC1167 minimal proxies (clones) would not normally pass this test, but is not guaranteed to
           * fail.
           */
          modifier onlyProxy() {
              require(address(this) != __self, "Function must be called through delegatecall");
              require(_getImplementation() == __self, "Function must be called through active proxy");
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Check that the execution is not being performed through a delegate call. This allows a function to be
           * callable on the implementing contract but not through proxies.
           */
          modifier notDelegated() {
              require(address(this) == __self, "UUPSUpgradeable: must not be called through delegatecall");
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Implementation of the ERC1822 {proxiableUUID} function. This returns the storage slot used by the
           * implementation. It is used to validate that the this implementation remains valid after an upgrade.
           *
           * IMPORTANT: A proxy pointing at a proxiable contract should not be considered proxiable itself, because this risks
           * bricking a proxy that upgrades to it, by delegating to itself until out of gas. Thus it is critical that this
           * function revert if invoked through a proxy. This is guaranteed by the `notDelegated` modifier.
           */
          function proxiableUUID() external view virtual override notDelegated returns (bytes32) {
              return _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Upgrade the implementation of the proxy to `newImplementation`.
           *
           * Calls {_authorizeUpgrade}.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function upgradeTo(address newImplementation) external virtual onlyProxy {
              _authorizeUpgrade(newImplementation);
              _upgradeToAndCallUUPS(newImplementation, new bytes(0), false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Upgrade the implementation of the proxy to `newImplementation`, and subsequently execute the function call
           * encoded in `data`.
           *
           * Calls {_authorizeUpgrade}.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function upgradeToAndCall(address newImplementation, bytes memory data) external payable virtual onlyProxy {
              _authorizeUpgrade(newImplementation);
              _upgradeToAndCallUUPS(newImplementation, data, true);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Function that should revert when `msg.sender` is not authorized to upgrade the contract. Called by
           * {upgradeTo} and {upgradeToAndCall}.
           *
           * Normally, this function will use an xref:access.adoc[access control] modifier such as {Ownable-onlyOwner}.
           *
           * ```solidity
           * function _authorizeUpgrade(address) internal override onlyOwner {}
           * ```
           */
          function _authorizeUpgrade(address newImplementation) internal virtual;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
       */
      interface IERC20 {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
           * another (`to`).
           *
           * Note that `value` may be zero.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
           * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
           */
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
           */
          function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
          /**
           * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `to`.
           *
           * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transfer(address to, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
           * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
           * zero by default.
           *
           * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
           */
          function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
          /**
           * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
           *
           * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
           *
           * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
           * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
           * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
           * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
           * desired value afterwards:
           * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `from` to `to` using the
           * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
           * allowance.
           *
           * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 amount
          ) external returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC721/IERC721Receiver.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @title ERC721 token receiver interface
       * @dev Interface for any contract that wants to support safeTransfers
       * from ERC721 asset contracts.
       */
      interface IERC721Receiver {
          /**
           * @dev Whenever an {IERC721} `tokenId` token is transferred to this contract via {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}
           * by `operator` from `from`, this function is called.
           *
           * It must return its Solidity selector to confirm the token transfer.
           * If any other value is returned or the interface is not implemented by the recipient, the transfer will be reverted.
           *
           * The selector can be obtained in Solidity with `IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector`.
           */
          function onERC721Received(
              address operator,
              address from,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external returns (bytes4);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (token/ERC721/utils/ERC721Holder.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../IERC721Receiver.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Implementation of the {IERC721Receiver} interface.
       *
       * Accepts all token transfers.
       * Make sure the contract is able to use its token with {IERC721-safeTransferFrom}, {IERC721-approve} or {IERC721-setApprovalForAll}.
       */
      contract ERC721Holder is IERC721Receiver {
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}.
           *
           * Always returns `IERC721Receiver.onERC721Received.selector`.
           */
          function onERC721Received(
              address,
              address,
              uint256,
              bytes memory
          ) public virtual override returns (bytes4) {
              return this.onERC721Received.selector;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library Address {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
                  if (returndata.length > 0) {
                      // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                          revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                      }
                  } else {
                      revert(errorMessage);
                  }
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/StorageSlot.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Library for reading and writing primitive types to specific storage slots.
       *
       * Storage slots are often used to avoid storage conflict when dealing with upgradeable contracts.
       * This library helps with reading and writing to such slots without the need for inline assembly.
       *
       * The functions in this library return Slot structs that contain a `value` member that can be used to read or write.
       *
       * Example usage to set ERC1967 implementation slot:
       * ```
       * contract ERC1967 {
       *     bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
       *
       *     function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
       *         return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
       *     }
       *
       *     function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) internal {
       *         require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
       *         StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
       *     }
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * _Available since v4.1 for `address`, `bool`, `bytes32`, and `uint256`._
       */
      library StorageSlot {
          struct AddressSlot {
              address value;
          }
          struct BooleanSlot {
              bool value;
          }
          struct Bytes32Slot {
              bytes32 value;
          }
          struct Uint256Slot {
              uint256 value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `AddressSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getAddressSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (AddressSlot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `BooleanSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getBooleanSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (BooleanSlot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `Bytes32Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getBytes32Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Bytes32Slot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `Uint256Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getUint256Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Uint256Slot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/AccessControl.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./IAccessControlUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../utils/StringsUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../utils/introspection/ERC165Upgradeable.sol";
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Contract module that allows children to implement role-based access
       * control mechanisms. This is a lightweight version that doesn't allow enumerating role
       * members except through off-chain means by accessing the contract event logs. Some
       * applications may benefit from on-chain enumerability, for those cases see
       * {AccessControlEnumerable}.
       *
       * Roles are referred to by their `bytes32` identifier. These should be exposed
       * in the external API and be unique. The best way to achieve this is by
       * using `public constant` hash digests:
       *
       * ```
       * bytes32 public constant MY_ROLE = keccak256("MY_ROLE");
       * ```
       *
       * Roles can be used to represent a set of permissions. To restrict access to a
       * function call, use {hasRole}:
       *
       * ```
       * function foo() public {
       *     require(hasRole(MY_ROLE, msg.sender));
       *     ...
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * Roles can be granted and revoked dynamically via the {grantRole} and
       * {revokeRole} functions. Each role has an associated admin role, and only
       * accounts that have a role's admin role can call {grantRole} and {revokeRole}.
       *
       * By default, the admin role for all roles is `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE`, which means
       * that only accounts with this role will be able to grant or revoke other
       * roles. More complex role relationships can be created by using
       * {_setRoleAdmin}.
       *
       * WARNING: The `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is also its own admin: it has permission to
       * grant and revoke this role. Extra precautions should be taken to secure
       * accounts that have been granted it.
       */
      abstract contract AccessControlUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable, IAccessControlUpgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable {
          function __AccessControl_init() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function __AccessControl_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          struct RoleData {
              mapping(address => bool) members;
              bytes32 adminRole;
          }
          mapping(bytes32 => RoleData) private _roles;
          bytes32 public constant DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE = 0x00;
          /**
           * @dev Modifier that checks that an account has a specific role. Reverts
           * with a standardized message including the required role.
           *
           * The format of the revert reason is given by the following regular expression:
           *
           *  /^AccessControl: account (0x[0-9a-f]{40}) is missing role (0x[0-9a-f]{64})$/
           *
           * _Available since v4.1._
           */
          modifier onlyRole(bytes32 role) {
              _checkRole(role);
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return interfaceId == type(IAccessControlUpgradeable).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           */
          function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return _roles[role].members[account];
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revert with a standard message if `_msgSender()` is missing `role`.
           * Overriding this function changes the behavior of the {onlyRole} modifier.
           *
           * Format of the revert message is described in {_checkRole}.
           *
           * _Available since v4.6._
           */
          function _checkRole(bytes32 role) internal view virtual {
              _checkRole(role, _msgSender());
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revert with a standard message if `account` is missing `role`.
           *
           * The format of the revert reason is given by the following regular expression:
           *
           *  /^AccessControl: account (0x[0-9a-f]{40}) is missing role (0x[0-9a-f]{64})$/
           */
          function _checkRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal view virtual {
              if (!hasRole(role, account)) {
                  revert(
                      string(
                          abi.encodePacked(
                              "AccessControl: account ",
                              StringsUpgradeable.toHexString(account),
                              " is missing role ",
                              StringsUpgradeable.toHexString(uint256(role), 32)
                          )
                      )
                  );
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
           * {revokeRole}.
           *
           * To change a role's admin, use {_setRoleAdmin}.
           */
          function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) public view virtual override returns (bytes32) {
              return _roles[role].adminRole;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleGranted} event.
           */
          function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override onlyRole(getRoleAdmin(role)) {
              _grantRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleRevoked} event.
           */
          function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override onlyRole(getRoleAdmin(role)) {
              _revokeRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
           *
           * Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
           * purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
           * if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
           *
           * If the calling account had been revoked `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must be `account`.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleRevoked} event.
           */
          function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
              require(account == _msgSender(), "AccessControl: can only renounce roles for self");
              _revokeRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
           * event. Note that unlike {grantRole}, this function doesn't perform any
           * checks on the calling account.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleGranted} event.
           *
           * [WARNING]
           * ====
           * This function should only be called from the constructor when setting
           * up the initial roles for the system.
           *
           * Using this function in any other way is effectively circumventing the admin
           * system imposed by {AccessControl}.
           * ====
           *
           * NOTE: This function is deprecated in favor of {_grantRole}.
           */
          function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              _grantRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Sets `adminRole` as ``role``'s admin role.
           *
           * Emits a {RoleAdminChanged} event.
           */
          function _setRoleAdmin(bytes32 role, bytes32 adminRole) internal virtual {
              bytes32 previousAdminRole = getRoleAdmin(role);
              _roles[role].adminRole = adminRole;
              emit RoleAdminChanged(role, previousAdminRole, adminRole);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * Internal function without access restriction.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleGranted} event.
           */
          function _grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              if (!hasRole(role, account)) {
                  _roles[role].members[account] = true;
                  emit RoleGranted(role, account, _msgSender());
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
           *
           * Internal function without access restriction.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleRevoked} event.
           */
          function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              if (hasRole(role, account)) {
                  _roles[role].members[account] = false;
                  emit RoleRevoked(role, account, _msgSender());
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[49] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/IAccessControl.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev External interface of AccessControl declared to support ERC165 detection.
       */
      interface IAccessControlUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `newAdminRole` is set as ``role``'s admin role, replacing `previousAdminRole`
           *
           * `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is the starting admin for all roles, despite
           * {RoleAdminChanged} not being emitted signaling this.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          event RoleAdminChanged(bytes32 indexed role, bytes32 indexed previousAdminRole, bytes32 indexed newAdminRole);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` is granted `role`.
           *
           * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call, an admin role
           * bearer except when using {AccessControl-_setupRole}.
           */
          event RoleGranted(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` is revoked `role`.
           *
           * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call:
           *   - if using `revokeRole`, it is the admin role bearer
           *   - if using `renounceRole`, it is the role bearer (i.e. `account`)
           */
          event RoleRevoked(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           */
          function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) external view returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
           * {revokeRole}.
           *
           * To change a role's admin, use {AccessControl-_setRoleAdmin}.
           */
          function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) external view returns (bytes32);
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           */
          function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           */
          function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
           *
           * Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
           * purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
           * if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
           *
           * If the calling account had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must be `account`.
           */
          function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
       * there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
       * specific functions.
       *
       * By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
       * can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
       *
       * This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
       * `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
       * the owner.
       */
      abstract contract OwnableUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
          address private _owner;
          event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
           */
          function __Ownable_init() internal onlyInitializing {
              __Ownable_init_unchained();
          }
          function __Ownable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
              _transferOwnership(_msgSender());
          }
          /**
           * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
           */
          modifier onlyOwner() {
              _checkOwner();
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
           */
          function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
              return _owner;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
           */
          function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
              require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
           * `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
           *
           * NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
           * thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
           */
          function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
              _transferOwnership(address(0));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
           * Can only be called by the current owner.
           */
          function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
              require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
              _transferOwnership(newOwner);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
           * Internal function without access restriction.
           */
          function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
              address oldOwner = _owner;
              _owner = newOwner;
              emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[49] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
      import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
       * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
       * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
       * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
       *
       * The initialization functions use a version number. Once a version number is used, it is consumed and cannot be
       * reused. This mechanism prevents re-execution of each "step" but allows the creation of new initialization steps in
       * case an upgrade adds a module that needs to be initialized.
       *
       * For example:
       *
       * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
       * ```
       * contract MyToken is ERC20Upgradeable {
       *     function initialize() initializer public {
       *         __ERC20_init("MyToken", "MTK");
       *     }
       * }
       * contract MyTokenV2 is MyToken, ERC20PermitUpgradeable {
       *     function initializeV2() reinitializer(2) public {
       *         __ERC20Permit_init("MyToken");
       *     }
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
       * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
       *
       * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
       * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
       *
       * [CAUTION]
       * ====
       * Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized.
       *
       * An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation
       * contract, which may impact the proxy. To prevent the implementation contract from being used, you should invoke
       * the {_disableInitializers} function in the constructor to automatically lock it when it is deployed:
       *
       * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
       * ```
       * /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
       * constructor() {
       *     _disableInitializers();
       * }
       * ```
       * ====
       */
      abstract contract Initializable {
          /**
           * @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
           * @custom:oz-retyped-from bool
           */
          uint8 private _initialized;
          /**
           * @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
           */
          bool private _initializing;
          /**
           * @dev Triggered when the contract has been initialized or reinitialized.
           */
          event Initialized(uint8 version);
          /**
           * @dev A modifier that defines a protected initializer function that can be invoked at most once. In its scope,
           * `onlyInitializing` functions can be used to initialize parent contracts.
           *
           * Similar to `reinitializer(1)`, except that functions marked with `initializer` can be nested in the context of a
           * constructor.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event.
           */
          modifier initializer() {
              bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing;
              require(
                  (isTopLevelCall && _initialized < 1) || (!AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this)) && _initialized == 1),
                  "Initializable: contract is already initialized"
              );
              _initialized = 1;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  _initializing = true;
              }
              _;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  _initializing = false;
                  emit Initialized(1);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev A modifier that defines a protected reinitializer function that can be invoked at most once, and only if the
           * contract hasn't been initialized to a greater version before. In its scope, `onlyInitializing` functions can be
           * used to initialize parent contracts.
           *
           * A reinitializer may be used after the original initialization step. This is essential to configure modules that
           * are added through upgrades and that require initialization.
           *
           * When `version` is 1, this modifier is similar to `initializer`, except that functions marked with `reinitializer`
           * cannot be nested. If one is invoked in the context of another, execution will revert.
           *
           * Note that versions can jump in increments greater than 1; this implies that if multiple reinitializers coexist in
           * a contract, executing them in the right order is up to the developer or operator.
           *
           * WARNING: setting the version to 255 will prevent any future reinitialization.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event.
           */
          modifier reinitializer(uint8 version) {
              require(!_initializing && _initialized < version, "Initializable: contract is already initialized");
              _initialized = version;
              _initializing = true;
              _;
              _initializing = false;
              emit Initialized(version);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
           * {initializer} and {reinitializer} modifiers, directly or indirectly.
           */
          modifier onlyInitializing() {
              require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing");
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Locks the contract, preventing any future reinitialization. This cannot be part of an initializer call.
           * Calling this in the constructor of a contract will prevent that contract from being initialized or reinitialized
           * to any version. It is recommended to use this to lock implementation contracts that are designed to be called
           * through proxies.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event the first time it is successfully executed.
           */
          function _disableInitializers() internal virtual {
              require(!_initializing, "Initializable: contract is initializing");
              if (_initialized != type(uint8).max) {
                  _initialized = type(uint8).max;
                  emit Initialized(type(uint8).max);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initialized`
           */
          function _getInitializedVersion() internal view returns (uint8) {
              return _initialized;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Internal function that returns the initialized version. Returns `_initializing`
           */
          function _isInitializing() internal view returns (bool) {
              return _initializing;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library AddressUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://consensys.net/diligence/blog/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling
           * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract.
           *
           * _Available since v4.8._
           */
          function verifyCallResultFromTarget(
              address target,
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  if (returndata.length == 0) {
                      // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty
                      // otherwise we already know that it was a contract
                      require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
                  }
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason or using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure {
              // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
              if (returndata.length > 0) {
                  // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                      revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                  }
              } else {
                  revert(errorMessage);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
       * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
       * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
       * manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
       * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
       * is concerned).
       *
       * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
       */
      abstract contract ContextUpgradeable is Initializable {
          function __Context_init() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function __Context_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
              return msg.data;
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[50] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Strings.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./math/MathUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev String operations.
       */
      library StringsUpgradeable {
          bytes16 private constant _SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
          uint8 private constant _ADDRESS_LENGTH = 20;
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 length = MathUpgradeable.log10(value) + 1;
                  string memory buffer = new string(length);
                  uint256 ptr;
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      ptr := add(buffer, add(32, length))
                  }
                  while (true) {
                      ptr--;
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          mstore8(ptr, byte(mod(value, 10), _SYMBOLS))
                      }
                      value /= 10;
                      if (value == 0) break;
                  }
                  return buffer;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              unchecked {
                  return toHexString(value, MathUpgradeable.log256(value) + 1);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
              buffer[0] = "0";
              buffer[1] = "x";
              for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
                  buffer[i] = _SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
                  value >>= 4;
              }
              require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
              return string(buffer);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts an `address` with fixed length of 20 bytes to its not checksummed ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(address addr) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return toHexString(uint256(uint160(addr)), _ADDRESS_LENGTH);
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./IERC165Upgradeable.sol";
      import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
       *
       * Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
       * for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
       *
       * ```solidity
       * function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
       *     return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
       */
      abstract contract ERC165Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC165Upgradeable {
          function __ERC165_init() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function __ERC165_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return interfaceId == type(IERC165Upgradeable).interfaceId;
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[50] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
       *
       * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
       * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
       *
       * For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
       */
      interface IERC165Upgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/math/Math.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Standard math utilities missing in the Solidity language.
       */
      library MathUpgradeable {
          enum Rounding {
              Down, // Toward negative infinity
              Up, // Toward infinity
              Zero // Toward zero
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers.
           */
          function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a > b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers.
           */
          function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the average of two numbers. The result is rounded towards
           * zero.
           */
          function average(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              // (a + b) / 2 can overflow.
              return (a & b) + (a ^ b) / 2;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the ceiling of the division of two numbers.
           *
           * This differs from standard division with `/` in that it rounds up instead
           * of rounding down.
           */
          function ceilDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              // (a + b - 1) / b can overflow on addition, so we distribute.
              return a == 0 ? 0 : (a - 1) / b + 1;
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates floor(x * y / denominator) with full precision. Throws if result overflows a uint256 or denominator == 0
           * @dev Original credit to Remco Bloemen under MIT license (https://xn--2-umb.com/21/muldiv)
           * with further edits by Uniswap Labs also under MIT license.
           */
          function mulDiv(
              uint256 x,
              uint256 y,
              uint256 denominator
          ) internal pure returns (uint256 result) {
              unchecked {
                  // 512-bit multiply [prod1 prod0] = x * y. Compute the product mod 2^256 and mod 2^256 - 1, then use
                  // use the Chinese Remainder Theorem to reconstruct the 512 bit result. The result is stored in two 256
                  // variables such that product = prod1 * 2^256 + prod0.
                  uint256 prod0; // Least significant 256 bits of the product
                  uint256 prod1; // Most significant 256 bits of the product
                  assembly {
                      let mm := mulmod(x, y, not(0))
                      prod0 := mul(x, y)
                      prod1 := sub(sub(mm, prod0), lt(mm, prod0))
                  }
                  // Handle non-overflow cases, 256 by 256 division.
                  if (prod1 == 0) {
                      return prod0 / denominator;
                  }
                  // Make sure the result is less than 2^256. Also prevents denominator == 0.
                  require(denominator > prod1);
                  ///////////////////////////////////////////////
                  // 512 by 256 division.
                  ///////////////////////////////////////////////
                  // Make division exact by subtracting the remainder from [prod1 prod0].
                  uint256 remainder;
                  assembly {
                      // Compute remainder using mulmod.
                      remainder := mulmod(x, y, denominator)
                      // Subtract 256 bit number from 512 bit number.
                      prod1 := sub(prod1, gt(remainder, prod0))
                      prod0 := sub(prod0, remainder)
                  }
                  // Factor powers of two out of denominator and compute largest power of two divisor of denominator. Always >= 1.
                  // See https://cs.stackexchange.com/q/138556/92363.
                  // Does not overflow because the denominator cannot be zero at this stage in the function.
                  uint256 twos = denominator & (~denominator + 1);
                  assembly {
                      // Divide denominator by twos.
                      denominator := div(denominator, twos)
                      // Divide [prod1 prod0] by twos.
                      prod0 := div(prod0, twos)
                      // Flip twos such that it is 2^256 / twos. If twos is zero, then it becomes one.
                      twos := add(div(sub(0, twos), twos), 1)
                  }
                  // Shift in bits from prod1 into prod0.
                  prod0 |= prod1 * twos;
                  // Invert denominator mod 2^256. Now that denominator is an odd number, it has an inverse modulo 2^256 such
                  // that denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^256. Compute the inverse by starting with a seed that is correct for
                  // four bits. That is, denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^4.
                  uint256 inverse = (3 * denominator) ^ 2;
                  // Use the Newton-Raphson iteration to improve the precision. Thanks to Hensel's lifting lemma, this also works
                  // in modular arithmetic, doubling the correct bits in each step.
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^8
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^16
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^32
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^64
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^128
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^256
                  // Because the division is now exact we can divide by multiplying with the modular inverse of denominator.
                  // This will give us the correct result modulo 2^256. Since the preconditions guarantee that the outcome is
                  // less than 2^256, this is the final result. We don't need to compute the high bits of the result and prod1
                  // is no longer required.
                  result = prod0 * inverse;
                  return result;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates x * y / denominator with full precision, following the selected rounding direction.
           */
          function mulDiv(
              uint256 x,
              uint256 y,
              uint256 denominator,
              Rounding rounding
          ) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = mulDiv(x, y, denominator);
              if (rounding == Rounding.Up && mulmod(x, y, denominator) > 0) {
                  result += 1;
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the square root of a number. If the number is not a perfect square, the value is rounded down.
           *
           * Inspired by Henry S. Warren, Jr.'s "Hacker's Delight" (Chapter 11).
           */
          function sqrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              if (a == 0) {
                  return 0;
              }
              // For our first guess, we get the biggest power of 2 which is smaller than the square root of the target.
              //
              // We know that the "msb" (most significant bit) of our target number `a` is a power of 2 such that we have
              // `msb(a) <= a < 2*msb(a)`. This value can be written `msb(a)=2**k` with `k=log2(a)`.
              //
              // This can be rewritten `2**log2(a) <= a < 2**(log2(a) + 1)`
              // → `sqrt(2**k) <= sqrt(a) < sqrt(2**(k+1))`
              // → `2**(k/2) <= sqrt(a) < 2**((k+1)/2) <= 2**(k/2 + 1)`
              //
              // Consequently, `2**(log2(a) / 2)` is a good first approximation of `sqrt(a)` with at least 1 correct bit.
              uint256 result = 1 << (log2(a) >> 1);
              // At this point `result` is an estimation with one bit of precision. We know the true value is a uint128,
              // since it is the square root of a uint256. Newton's method converges quadratically (precision doubles at
              // every iteration). We thus need at most 7 iteration to turn our partial result with one bit of precision
              // into the expected uint128 result.
              unchecked {
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  return min(result, a / result);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates sqrt(a), following the selected rounding direction.
           */
          function sqrt(uint256 a, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = sqrt(a);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && result * result < a ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 2, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log2(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >> 128 > 0) {
                      value >>= 128;
                      result += 128;
                  }
                  if (value >> 64 > 0) {
                      value >>= 64;
                      result += 64;
                  }
                  if (value >> 32 > 0) {
                      value >>= 32;
                      result += 32;
                  }
                  if (value >> 16 > 0) {
                      value >>= 16;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >> 8 > 0) {
                      value >>= 8;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >> 4 > 0) {
                      value >>= 4;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >> 2 > 0) {
                      value >>= 2;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >> 1 > 0) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 2, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log2(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log2(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << result < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log10(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >= 10**64) {
                      value /= 10**64;
                      result += 64;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10**32) {
                      value /= 10**32;
                      result += 32;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10**16) {
                      value /= 10**16;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10**8) {
                      value /= 10**8;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10**4) {
                      value /= 10**4;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10**2) {
                      value /= 10**2;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10**1) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log10(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log10(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 10**result < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 256, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           *
           * Adding one to the result gives the number of pairs of hex symbols needed to represent `value` as a hex string.
           */
          function log256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >> 128 > 0) {
                      value >>= 128;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >> 64 > 0) {
                      value >>= 64;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >> 32 > 0) {
                      value >>= 32;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >> 16 > 0) {
                      value >>= 16;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >> 8 > 0) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log256(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log256(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << (result << 3) < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
      pragma solidity 0.8.16;
      interface IUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @notice Contract version number.
           *
           * @return uint256 The version number.
           */
          function version() external pure returns (uint256);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
      import "contracts-upgradeable/contracts/access/OwnableUpgradeable.sol";
      import "contracts-upgradeable/contracts/access/AccessControlUpgradeable.sol";
      abstract contract FixinAccessControlUpgradeable is AccessControlUpgradeable, OwnableUpgradeable {
          bytes32 internal constant MINTER_ROLE = keccak256("MINTER_ROLE");
          bytes32 internal constant BURNER_ROLE = keccak256("BURNER_ROLE");
          bytes32 internal constant GOVERNOR_ROLE = keccak256("GOVENOR_ROLE");
          function _setGovernor(address _governor) internal onlyOwner {
              _grantRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE, _governor);
          }
          function isGovernor() internal view returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE, msg.sender) || owner() == msg.sender;
          }
          function setGovernor(address governor) public virtual onlyOwner {
              _setGovernor(governor);
          }
      }// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
      pragma solidity 0.8.16;
      import "ERC721A/IERC721A.sol";
      abstract contract FixinERC721Spender {
          uint256 private constant ADDRESS_MASK = 0x000000000000000000000000ffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffffff;
          /// @dev Transfers an ERC721 asset from `owner` to `to`.
          /// @param token The address of the ERC721 token contract.
          /// @param owner The owner of the asset.
          /// @param to The recipient of the asset.
          /// @param tokenId The token ID of the asset to transfer.
          function _transferERC721AssetFrom(IERC721A token, address owner, address to, uint256 tokenId) internal {
              require(address(token) != address(this), "FixinERC721Spender/CANNOT_INVOKE_SELF");
              assembly {
                  let ptr := mload(0x40) // free memory pointer
                  // selector for transferFrom(address,address,uint256)
                  mstore(ptr, 0x23b872dd00000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000)
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x04), and(owner, ADDRESS_MASK))
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x24), and(to, ADDRESS_MASK))
                  mstore(add(ptr, 0x44), tokenId)
                  let success := call(gas(), and(token, ADDRESS_MASK), 0, ptr, 0x64, 0, 0)
                  if iszero(success) {
                      let rdsize := returndatasize()
                      returndatacopy(ptr, 0, rdsize)
                      revert(ptr, rdsize)
                  }
              }
          }
      }pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
      library LibMathRichErrors {
              // bytes4(keccak256("Uint256BinOpError(uint8,uint256,uint256)"))
          bytes4 internal constant UINT256_BINOP_ERROR_SELECTOR = 0xe946c1bb;
          // bytes4(keccak256("Uint256DowncastError(uint8,uint256)"))
          bytes4 internal constant UINT256_DOWNCAST_ERROR_SELECTOR = 0xc996af7b;
          enum BinOpErrorCodes {
              ADDITION_OVERFLOW,
              MULTIPLICATION_OVERFLOW,
              SUBTRACTION_UNDERFLOW,
              DIVISION_BY_ZERO
          }
          enum DowncastErrorCodes {
              VALUE_TOO_LARGE_TO_DOWNCAST_TO_UINT32,
              VALUE_TOO_LARGE_TO_DOWNCAST_TO_UINT64,
              VALUE_TOO_LARGE_TO_DOWNCAST_TO_UINT96,
              VALUE_TOO_LARGE_TO_DOWNCAST_TO_UINT128
          }
          function Uint256BinOpError(BinOpErrorCodes errorCode, uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              return abi.encodeWithSelector(UINT256_BINOP_ERROR_SELECTOR, errorCode, a, b);
          }
          function Uint256DowncastError(DowncastErrorCodes errorCode, uint256 a) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              return abi.encodeWithSelector(UINT256_DOWNCAST_ERROR_SELECTOR, errorCode, a);
          }
      }// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
      // borrowed from 0x protocol
      library Errors {
          // bytes4(keccak256("Error(string)"))
          bytes4 internal constant STANDARD_ERROR_SELECTOR = 0x08c379a0;
          /// @dev ABI encode a standard, string revert error payload.
          ///      This is the same payload that would be included by a `revert(string)`
          ///      solidity statement. It has the function signature `Error(string)`.
          /// @param message The error string.
          /// @return The ABI encoded error.
          function StandardError(string memory message) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              return abi.encodeWithSelector(STANDARD_ERROR_SELECTOR, bytes(message));
          }
          /// @dev Reverts an encoded rich revert reason `errorData`.
          /// @param errorData ABI encoded error data.
          function rrevert(bytes memory errorData) internal pure {
              assembly {
                  revert(add(errorData, 0x20), mload(errorData))
              }
          }
      }pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
      import "./errors.sol";
      import "./errors/LibMathErrors.sol";
      library LibSafeMath {
          function safeMul(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              if (a == 0) {
                  return 0;
              }
              uint256 c = a * b;
              if (c / a != b) {
                  Errors.rrevert(
                      LibMathRichErrors.Uint256BinOpError(
                          LibMathRichErrors.BinOpErrorCodes.MULTIPLICATION_OVERFLOW,
                          a,
                          b
                      )
                  );
              }
              return c;
          }
          function safeDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              if (b == 0) {
                Errors.rrevert(
                  LibMathRichErrors.Uint256BinOpError(
                      LibMathRichErrors.BinOpErrorCodes.DIVISION_BY_ZERO,
                      a,
                      b
                      )
                  );
              }
              uint256 c = a / b;
              return c;
          }
          function safeSub(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              if (b > a) {
                  Errors.rrevert(
                      LibMathRichErrors.Uint256BinOpError(
                          LibMathRichErrors.BinOpErrorCodes.SUBTRACTION_UNDERFLOW,
                          a,
                          b
                      )
                  );
              }
              return a - b;
          }
          function safeAdd(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 c = a + b;
              if (c < a) {
                  Errors.rrevert(
                      LibMathRichErrors.Uint256BinOpError(
                          LibMathRichErrors.BinOpErrorCodes.ADDITION_OVERFLOW,
                          a,
                          b
                      )
                  );
              }
              return c;
          }
          function max256(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a >= b ? a : b;
          }
          function min256(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          function safeMul128(uint128 a, uint128 b) internal pure returns (uint128) {
              if (a == 0) {
                  return 0;
              }
              uint128 c = a * b;
              if (c / a != b) {
                  Errors.rrevert(
                      LibMathRichErrors.Uint256BinOpError(
                          LibMathRichErrors.BinOpErrorCodes.MULTIPLICATION_OVERFLOW,
                          a,
                          b
                      )
                  );
              }
              return c;
          }
          function safeDiv128(uint128 a, uint128 b) internal pure returns (uint128) {
              if (b == 0) {
                   Errors.rrevert(
                      LibMathRichErrors.Uint256BinOpError(
                          LibMathRichErrors.BinOpErrorCodes.DIVISION_BY_ZERO,
                          a,
                          b
                      )
                  );
              }
              uint128 c = a / b;
              return c;
          }
          function safeSub128(uint128 a, uint128 b) internal pure returns (uint128) {
              if (b > a) {
                  Errors.rrevert(
                      LibMathRichErrors.Uint256BinOpError(
                          LibMathRichErrors.BinOpErrorCodes.SUBTRACTION_UNDERFLOW,
                          a,
                          b
                      )
                  );
              }
              return a - b;
          }
          function safeAdd128(uint128 a, uint128 b) internal pure returns (uint128) {
              uint128 c = a + b;
              if (c < a) {
                   Errors.rrevert(
                      LibMathRichErrors.Uint256BinOpError(
                          LibMathRichErrors.BinOpErrorCodes.ADDITION_OVERFLOW,
                          a,
                          b
                      )
                  );
              }
              return c;
          }
          function max128(uint128 a, uint128 b) internal pure returns (uint128) {
              return a >= b ? a : b;
          }
          function min128(uint128 a, uint128 b) internal pure returns (uint128) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          function safeDowncastToUint128(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint128) {
              if (a > type(uint128).max) {
              }
              return uint128(a);
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.16;
      import "ERC721A/IERC721A.sol";
      import "openzeppelin-contracts/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol";
      import "openzeppelin-contracts/contracts/token/ERC721/utils/ERC721Holder.sol";
      import "openzeppelin-contracts/contracts/proxy/utils/UUPSUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../interfaces/IStakingSBT.sol";
      import "../../../lib/fixins/FixinAccessControlUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../../../lib/fixins/FixinTransfer.sol";
      import "../../../lib/types/safeMath.sol";
      import "../../../interfaces/IUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../storage/StakingStorage.sol";
      contract NFTStaking is Initializable, FixinAccessControlUpgradeable, ERC721Holder, UUPSUpgradeable, StakingStorage, FixinERC721Spender, IUpgradeable {
          
          using LibSafeMath for uint256;
          event Staked(address indexed user, uint256 tokenId);
          event Unstaked(address indexed user, uint256 tokenId);
          event RewardEarned(address indexed user, uint256 numOfStakes, uint256 earn);
          event Distributed(uint256 indexed distributedAt, uint256 totalDistributed);
          event RewardClaimed(address indexed user, uint256 indexed claimedAt, uint256 numOfClaimed);
          event UpdatedStakerBalance(address[] indexed users, uint256[] balance);
          modifier rewardsStartTimePassed() {
              require(block.timestamp >= rewardsStartTime, "Rewards period has not started");
              _;
          }
          constructor() {
              _disableInitializers();
          }
          function initializeTiers_() private {
              nftPassTiers[0] = 278;
              nftPassTiers[1] = 556;
              nftPassTiers[2] = 1111;
              nftPassTiers[3] = 1667;
              nftPassTiers[4] = 2222;
              nftPassTiers[5] = 2778;
              nftPassTiers[6] = 3333;
              nftPassTiers[7] = 3889;
              rewardTiers[0] = 685;
              rewardTiers[1] = 913;
              rewardTiers[2] = 1142;
              rewardTiers[3] = 1370;
              rewardTiers[4] = 1598;
              rewardTiers[5] = 1826;
              rewardTiers[6] = 2055;
              rewardTiers[7] = 2283;
          }
          function initialize(address nftAddress, address stakingSBT, address tokenAddress, address engineOwner) public initializer {
              eapPass = IERC721A(nftAddress);
              token = IERC20(tokenAddress);
              stakingPass = IStakingSBT(stakingSBT);
              initializeTiers_();
              _transferOwnership(engineOwner);
          }
          ///@dev required by the OZ UUPS module
          function _authorizeUpgrade(address) internal override onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) {}
          function _stakeSingle(uint256 tokenId) private {
              require(eapPass.ownerOf(tokenId) == msg.sender, "You do not own this NFT");
              //Transfer the NFT from the user to the staking contract
              //IERC721A(eapPass).safeTransferFrom(msg.sender, address(this), tokenId);
              _transferERC721AssetFrom(eapPass, msg.sender, address(this), tokenId);
              if (stakerBalances[msg.sender] == 0) {
                  stakers.push(msg.sender);
              }
              // Store the stake information for the user
              stakerBalances[msg.sender] += 1;
              totalStaked += 1;
               // Emit an event
              emit Staked(msg.sender, tokenId);
          }
          function stake(uint256 tokenId) public {
              _stakeSingle(tokenId);
              // mint sbt
              stakingPass.mint(msg.sender, tokenId);    
          }
          function batchStake(uint256[] memory tokens) public {
              for (uint i=0; i<tokens.length; i++) {
                  uint256 t = tokens[i];
                  _stakeSingle(t);
              }
              stakingPass.batchMint(msg.sender, tokens);
          }
          function _unstakeSingle(uint256 tokenId) private {
              uint256 passId = stakingPass.underlyingToken(tokenId);
              require(eapPass.ownerOf(passId) == address(this), "token is not staked!!");
              // Transfer the NFT back to the user
              _transferERC721AssetFrom(eapPass, address(this), msg.sender, passId);
              stakerBalances[msg.sender] -= 1;
              totalStaked -= 1;
              // clear the staker balance for the user
              if (stakerBalances[msg.sender] == 0) {
                  delete stakerBalances[msg.sender];
              }
              emit Unstaked(msg.sender, tokenId);
          }
          function batchUnstake(uint256[] memory tokens) public {
               for (uint i=0; i<tokens.length; i++) {
                   _unstakeSingle(tokens[i]);
               }
               stakingPass.batchBurn(tokens);
          }
          
          // unstake by providing your SBT id
          function unstake(uint256 tokenId) public {
              _unstakeSingle(tokenId);
              stakingPass.burn(tokenId);
              // Emit an event
          }
          function calcluateDistribution_(uint totalStakedAmt) public view returns(uint reward) {
              require(nftPassTiers.length > 0, "pass tiers and reward tiers must be defined before distribution");
              if (totalStakedAmt == 0) {
                  return 0;
              }
              for (uint i =0; i < nftPassTiers.length; ++i) {
                  if (totalStakedAmt < nftPassTiers[i]) {
                      if (i > 0) {
                          return rewardTiers[i - 1];
                      } else {
                          return 0;
                      }
                  }
              }
              if (totalStakedAmt >= nftPassTiers[7]) {
                  return rewardTiers[7];
              }
          }
          function claimRewards() public rewardsStartTimePassed {
              uint256 userRewards = rewardBalances[msg.sender];
              // Transfer the rewards to the user
              token.transfer(msg.sender, userRewards);
              emit RewardClaimed(msg.sender, block.timestamp, userRewards);
          }
          function setHoldingNFT(address tokenAddress) external onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) {
              eapPass = IERC721A(tokenAddress);
          }
          function setToken(address tokenAddress) external onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) {
              token = IERC20(tokenAddress);
          }
          function setStakingSBT(address tokenAddress) external onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) {
              stakingPass = IStakingSBT(tokenAddress);
          }
          function setClaimStart(uint256 claimStartTime) external onlyOwner {
              rewardsStartTime = claimStartTime;
          }
          function getStakedBalance(address staker) external view returns (uint256)  {
              return stakerBalances[staker];
          }
          function getClaimableBalance(address staker) external view returns (uint256)  {
              return rewardBalances[staker];
          }
          function getCurrentEarnings(address staker) external view returns (uint256) {
              if (stakerBalances[staker] == 0) {
                  return 0;
              }
              uint256 reward = calcluateDistribution_(totalStaked);
              return reward.safeDiv(totalStaked).safeMul(stakerBalances[staker]);
          }
          function listStakers() public view returns(address[] memory) {
              return stakers;
          }
          function fetchStakers() public view returns(address[] memory) {
              address[] memory _stakers = new address[](stakers.length);
              uint256 j = 0;
              for (uint256 i = 0; i < stakers.length; i++) {
                  bool duplicate = false;
                  for (uint256 k = 0; k < j; k++) {
                      if (_stakers[k] == stakers[i]) {
                          duplicate = true;
                          break;
                      }
                  }
                  if (!duplicate && stakerBalances[stakers[i]] > 0) {
                      _stakers[j++] = stakers[i];
                  }
              }
              assembly {
                  mstore(_stakers, j)
              }
              return _stakers;
          }
          function updateRewardBalance(address[] memory stakers_, uint256[] memory balances_ ) external onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) { 
              require(stakers_.length == balances_.length, "number of stakers must match number of balances to update");
              for (uint i = 0; i < stakers_.length; ++i) {
                  rewardBalances[stakers_[i]] =  balances_[i];
              }
              emit UpdatedStakerBalance(stakers_, balances_);
          }
          function version() external pure override returns (uint256) {
              return _VERSION;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
      pragma solidity ^0.8.16;
      interface IStakingSBT {
         function mint(address staker, uint256 passId) external payable;
         function batchMint(address staker, uint256[] memory nfts) external payable;
         function underlyingToken(uint256 tokenId) external view returns(uint256);
         function burn(uint256 tokenId) external;
         function batchBurn(uint256[] memory nfts) external;
         function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
      pragma solidity 0.8.16;
      import "ERC721A/IERC721A.sol";
      import "../interfaces/IStakingSBT.sol";
      import "openzeppelin-contracts/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol";
      abstract contract StakingStorage {
          /*
          tier 1: >= 5%, 278 NFT staked,    we give away 685 $ATT tokens
          tier 2: >= 10%, 556 NFT staked,   we give away 913 $ATT tokens
          tier 3: >= 20%, 1111 NFT staked,  we give away 1142 $ATT tokens
          tier 4: >= 30%, 1667 NFT staked,  we give away 1370 $ATT tokens
          tier 5: >= 40%, 2222 NFT staked,  we give away 1598 $ATT tokens
          tier 6: >= 50%, 2778 NFT staked,  we give away 1826 $ATT tokens
          tier 7: >= 60%, 3333 NFT staked,  we give away 2055 $ATT tokens
          tier 8: >= 70%, 3889 NFT staked,  we give away 2283 $ATT tokens
          */
          // constant
          uint256 internal constant _VERSION = 8;
          address[] public stakers;
          mapping (address => uint256) public stakerBalances;
          mapping (address => uint256) internal rewardBalances;
          uint256 public totalStaked;
          uint[8] public rewardTiers;
          uint[8] public nftPassTiers;
          IERC721A public eapPass;
          IStakingSBT public stakingPass;
          IERC20 public token;
          uint256 public rewardsStartTime;
          uint256 public totalDistributed;
      }

      File 5 of 5: StakingSBT
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721A.
       */
      interface IERC721A {
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
           */
          error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
          /**
           * Cannot mint to the zero address.
           */
          error MintToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
           */
          error MintZeroQuantity();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token must be owned by `from`.
           */
          error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
          /**
           * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
           * ERC721Receiver interface.
           */
          error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
          /**
           * Cannot transfer to the zero address.
           */
          error TransferToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
           */
          error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
          /**
           * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
           */
          error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
          // =============================================================
          //                            STRUCTS
          // =============================================================
          struct TokenOwnership {
              // The address of the owner.
              address addr;
              // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
              uint64 startTimestamp;
              // Whether the token has been burned.
              bool burned;
              // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
              uint24 extraData;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                         TOKEN COUNTERS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC721
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
           * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
           * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
           * to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
           * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
           * whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
          // =============================================================
          //                           IERC2309
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
           * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
           *
           * See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
           */
          event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      library ERC721AStorage {
          // Bypass for a `--via-ir` bug (https://github.com/chiru-labs/ERC721A/pull/364).
          struct TokenApprovalRef {
              address value;
          }
          struct Layout {
              // =============================================================
              //                            STORAGE
              // =============================================================
              // The next token ID to be minted.
              uint256 _currentIndex;
              // The number of tokens burned.
              uint256 _burnCounter;
              // Token name
              string _name;
              // Token symbol
              string _symbol;
              // Mapping from token ID to ownership details
              // An empty struct value does not necessarily mean the token is unowned.
              // See {_packedOwnershipOf} implementation for details.
              //
              // Bits Layout:
              // - [0..159]   `addr`
              // - [160..223] `startTimestamp`
              // - [224]      `burned`
              // - [225]      `nextInitialized`
              // - [232..255] `extraData`
              mapping(uint256 => uint256) _packedOwnerships;
              // Mapping owner address to address data.
              //
              // Bits Layout:
              // - [0..63]    `balance`
              // - [64..127]  `numberMinted`
              // - [128..191] `numberBurned`
              // - [192..255] `aux`
              mapping(address => uint256) _packedAddressData;
              // Mapping from token ID to approved address.
              mapping(uint256 => ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef) _tokenApprovals;
              // Mapping from owner to operator approvals
              mapping(address => mapping(address => bool)) _operatorApprovals;
          }
          bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.ERC721A');
          function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
              bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
              assembly {
                  l.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import './IERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
      import {ERC721AStorage} from './ERC721AStorage.sol';
      import './ERC721A__Initializable.sol';
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721 token receiver.
       */
      interface ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable {
          function onERC721Received(
              address operator,
              address from,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external returns (bytes4);
      }
      /**
       * @title ERC721A
       *
       * @dev Implementation of the [ERC721](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-721)
       * Non-Fungible Token Standard, including the Metadata extension.
       * Optimized for lower gas during batch mints.
       *
       * Token IDs are minted in sequential order (e.g. 0, 1, 2, 3, ...)
       * starting from `_startTokenId()`.
       *
       * Assumptions:
       *
       * - An owner cannot have more than 2**64 - 1 (max value of uint64) of supply.
       * - The maximum token ID cannot exceed 2**256 - 1 (max value of uint256).
       */
      contract ERC721AUpgradeable is ERC721A__Initializable, IERC721AUpgradeable {
          using ERC721AStorage for ERC721AStorage.Layout;
          // =============================================================
          //                           CONSTANTS
          // =============================================================
          // Mask of an entry in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY = (1 << 64) - 1;
          // The bit position of `numberMinted` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED = 64;
          // The bit position of `numberBurned` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED = 128;
          // The bit position of `aux` in packed address data.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_AUX = 192;
          // Mask of all 256 bits in packed address data except the 64 bits for `aux`.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 192) - 1;
          // The bit position of `startTimestamp` in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP = 160;
          // The bit mask of the `burned` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_BURNED = 1 << 224;
          // The bit position of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 225;
          // The bit mask of the `nextInitialized` bit in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED = 1 << 225;
          // The bit position of `extraData` in packed ownership.
          uint256 private constant _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA = 232;
          // Mask of all 256 bits in a packed ownership except the 24 bits for `extraData`.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT = (1 << 232) - 1;
          // The mask of the lower 160 bits for addresses.
          uint256 private constant _BITMASK_ADDRESS = (1 << 160) - 1;
          // The maximum `quantity` that can be minted with {_mintERC2309}.
          // This limit is to prevent overflows on the address data entries.
          // For a limit of 5000, a total of 3.689e15 calls to {_mintERC2309}
          // is required to cause an overflow, which is unrealistic.
          uint256 private constant _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT = 5000;
          // The `Transfer` event signature is given by:
          // `keccak256(bytes("Transfer(address,address,uint256)"))`.
          bytes32 private constant _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE =
              0xddf252ad1be2c89b69c2b068fc378daa952ba7f163c4a11628f55a4df523b3ef;
          // =============================================================
          //                          CONSTRUCTOR
          // =============================================================
          function __ERC721A_init(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              __ERC721A_init_unchained(name_, symbol_);
          }
          function __ERC721A_init_unchained(string memory name_, string memory symbol_) internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._name = name_;
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol = symbol_;
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = _startTokenId();
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                   TOKEN COUNTING OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the starting token ID.
           * To change the starting token ID, please override this function.
           */
          function _startTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the next token ID to be minted.
           */
          function _nextTokenId() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              // Counter underflow is impossible as _burnCounter cannot be incremented
              // more than `_currentIndex - _startTokenId()` times.
              unchecked {
                  return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total amount of tokens minted in the contract.
           */
          function _totalMinted() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              // Counter underflow is impossible as `_currentIndex` does not decrement,
              // and it is initialized to `_startTokenId()`.
              unchecked {
                  return ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex - _startTokenId();
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens burned.
           */
          function _totalBurned() internal view virtual returns (uint256) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                    ADDRESS DATA OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) public view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              if (owner == address(0)) _revert(BalanceQueryForZeroAddress.selector);
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the number of tokens minted by `owner`.
           */
          function _numberMinted(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
              return
                  (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the number of tokens burned by or on behalf of `owner`.
           */
          function _numberBurned(address owner) internal view returns (uint256) {
              return
                  (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS_DATA_ENTRY;
          }
          /**
           * Returns the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
           */
          function _getAux(address owner) internal view returns (uint64) {
              return uint64(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] >> _BITPOS_AUX);
          }
          /**
           * Sets the auxiliary data for `owner`. (e.g. number of whitelist mint slots used).
           * If there are multiple variables, please pack them into a uint64.
           */
          function _setAux(address owner, uint64 aux) internal virtual {
              uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner];
              uint256 auxCasted;
              // Cast `aux` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
              assembly {
                  auxCasted := aux
              }
              packed = (packed & _BITMASK_AUX_COMPLEMENT) | (auxCasted << _BITPOS_AUX);
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[owner] = packed;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              // The interface IDs are constants representing the first 4 bytes
              // of the XOR of all function selectors in the interface.
              // See: [ERC165](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165)
              // (e.g. `bytes4(i.functionA.selector ^ i.functionB.selector ^ ...)`)
              return
                  interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
                  interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
                  interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f; // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721Metadata.
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._name;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._symbol;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              if (!_exists(tokenId)) _revert(URIQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
              string memory baseURI = _baseURI();
              return bytes(baseURI).length != 0 ? string(abi.encodePacked(baseURI, _toString(tokenId))) : '';
          }
          /**
           * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
           * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
           * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
           */
          function _baseURI() internal view virtual returns (string memory) {
              return '';
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                     OWNERSHIPS OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              return address(uint160(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId)));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Gas spent here starts off proportional to the maximum mint batch size.
           * It gradually moves to O(1) as tokens get transferred around over time.
           */
          function _ownershipOf(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
              return _unpackedOwnership(_packedOwnershipOf(tokenId));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct at `index`.
           */
          function _ownershipAt(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (TokenOwnership memory) {
              return _unpackedOwnership(ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index]);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether the ownership slot at `index` is initialized.
           * An uninitialized slot does not necessarily mean that the slot has no owner.
           */
          function _ownershipIsInitialized(uint256 index) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] != 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the ownership slot minted at `index` for efficiency purposes.
           */
          function _initializeOwnershipAt(uint256 index) internal virtual {
              if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] == 0) {
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = _packedOwnershipOf(index);
              }
          }
          /**
           * Returns the packed ownership data of `tokenId`.
           */
          function _packedOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) private view returns (uint256 packed) {
              if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) {
                  packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId];
                  // If the data at the starting slot does not exist, start the scan.
                  if (packed == 0) {
                      if (tokenId >= ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
                      // Invariant:
                      // There will always be an initialized ownership slot
                      // (i.e. `ownership.addr != address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
                      // before an unintialized ownership slot
                      // (i.e. `ownership.addr == address(0) && ownership.burned == false`)
                      // Hence, `tokenId` will not underflow.
                      //
                      // We can directly compare the packed value.
                      // If the address is zero, packed will be zero.
                      for (;;) {
                          unchecked {
                              packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[--tokenId];
                          }
                          if (packed == 0) continue;
                          if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) return packed;
                          // Otherwise, the token is burned, and we must revert.
                          // This handles the case of batch burned tokens, where only the burned bit
                          // of the starting slot is set, and remaining slots are left uninitialized.
                          _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
                      }
                  }
                  // Otherwise, the data exists and we can skip the scan.
                  // This is possible because we have already achieved the target condition.
                  // This saves 2143 gas on transfers of initialized tokens.
                  // If the token is not burned, return `packed`. Otherwise, revert.
                  if (packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0) return packed;
              }
              _revert(OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the unpacked `TokenOwnership` struct from `packed`.
           */
          function _unpackedOwnership(uint256 packed) private pure returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership) {
              ownership.addr = address(uint160(packed));
              ownership.startTimestamp = uint64(packed >> _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP);
              ownership.burned = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED != 0;
              ownership.extraData = uint24(packed >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Packs ownership data into a single uint256.
           */
          function _packOwnershipData(address owner, uint256 flags) private view returns (uint256 result) {
              assembly {
                  // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // `owner | (block.timestamp << _BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP) | flags`.
                  result := or(owner, or(shl(_BITPOS_START_TIMESTAMP, timestamp()), flags))
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `nextInitialized` flag set if `quantity` equals 1.
           */
          function _nextInitializedFlag(uint256 quantity) private pure returns (uint256 result) {
              // For branchless setting of the `nextInitialized` flag.
              assembly {
                  // `(quantity == 1) << _BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED`.
                  result := shl(_BITPOS_NEXT_INITIALIZED, eq(quantity, 1))
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                      APPROVAL OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account. See {ERC721A-_approve}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) public payable virtual override {
              _approve(to, tokenId, true);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) public view virtual override returns (address) {
              if (!_exists(tokenId)) _revert(ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken.selector);
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool approved) public virtual override {
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[_msgSenderERC721A()][operator] = approved;
              emit ApprovalForAll(_msgSenderERC721A(), operator, approved);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return ERC721AStorage.layout()._operatorApprovals[owner][operator];
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `tokenId` exists.
           *
           * Tokens can be managed by their owner or approved accounts via {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Tokens start existing when they are minted. See {_mint}.
           */
          function _exists(uint256 tokenId) internal view virtual returns (bool result) {
              if (_startTokenId() <= tokenId) {
                  if (tokenId < ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                      uint256 packed;
                      while ((packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId]) == 0) --tokenId;
                      result = packed & _BITMASK_BURNED == 0;
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns whether `msgSender` is equal to `approvedAddress` or `owner`.
           */
          function _isSenderApprovedOrOwner(
              address approvedAddress,
              address owner,
              address msgSender
          ) private pure returns (bool result) {
              assembly {
                  // Mask `owner` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  owner := and(owner, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // Mask `msgSender` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  msgSender := and(msgSender, _BITMASK_ADDRESS)
                  // `msgSender == owner || msgSender == approvedAddress`.
                  result := or(eq(msgSender, owner), eq(msgSender, approvedAddress))
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the storage slot and value for the approved address of `tokenId`.
           */
          function _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(uint256 tokenId)
              private
              view
              returns (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress)
          {
              ERC721AStorage.TokenApprovalRef storage tokenApproval = ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId];
              // The following is equivalent to `approvedAddress = _tokenApprovals[tokenId].value`.
              assembly {
                  approvedAddressSlot := tokenApproval.slot
                  approvedAddress := sload(approvedAddressSlot)
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                      TRANSFER OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) public payable virtual override {
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
              // Mask `from` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
              from = address(uint160(uint256(uint160(from)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS));
              if (address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked)) != from) _revert(TransferFromIncorrectOwner.selector);
              (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
              // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
              if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
                  if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) _revert(TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner.
              assembly {
                  if approvedAddress {
                      // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
                      sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
                  }
              }
              // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
              // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
              // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // We can directly increment and decrement the balances.
                  --ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from]; // Updates: `balance -= 1`.
                  ++ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to]; // Updates: `balance += 1`.
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the next owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of transfering.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED | _nextExtraData(from, to, prevOwnershipPacked)
                  );
                  // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
                  if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
                      uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
                      // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
                          // If the next slot is within bounds.
                          if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                              // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
                              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
                          }
                      }
                  }
              }
              // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
              uint256 toMasked = uint256(uint160(to)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS;
              assembly {
                  // Emit the `Transfer` event.
                  log4(
                      0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
                      0, // End of data (0, since no data).
                      _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
                      from, // `from`.
                      toMasked, // `to`.
                      tokenId // `tokenId`.
                  )
              }
              if (toMasked == 0) _revert(TransferToZeroAddress.selector);
              _afterTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, 1);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) public payable virtual override {
              safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '');
          }
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory _data
          ) public payable virtual override {
              transferFrom(from, to, tokenId);
              if (to.code.length != 0)
                  if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(from, to, tokenId, _data)) {
                      _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                  }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called before a set of serially-ordered token IDs
           * are about to be transferred. This includes minting.
           * And also called before burning one token.
           *
           * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
           * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _beforeTokenTransfers(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 startTokenId,
              uint256 quantity
          ) internal virtual {}
          /**
           * @dev Hook that is called after a set of serially-ordered token IDs
           * have been transferred. This includes minting.
           * And also called after one token has been burned.
           *
           * `startTokenId` - the first token ID to be transferred.
           * `quantity` - the amount to be transferred.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` has been
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` has been minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` has been burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _afterTokenTransfers(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 startTokenId,
              uint256 quantity
          ) internal virtual {}
          /**
           * @dev Private function to invoke {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received} on a target contract.
           *
           * `from` - Previous owner of the given token ID.
           * `to` - Target address that will receive the token.
           * `tokenId` - Token ID to be transferred.
           * `_data` - Optional data to send along with the call.
           *
           * Returns whether the call correctly returned the expected magic value.
           */
          function _checkContractOnERC721Received(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes memory _data
          ) private returns (bool) {
              try
                  ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received(_msgSenderERC721A(), from, tokenId, _data)
              returns (bytes4 retval) {
                  return retval == ERC721A__IERC721ReceiverUpgradeable(to).onERC721Received.selector;
              } catch (bytes memory reason) {
                  if (reason.length == 0) {
                      _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                  }
                  assembly {
                      revert(add(32, reason), mload(reason))
                  }
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        MINT OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
           */
          function _mint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
              if (quantity == 0) _revert(MintZeroQuantity.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
              // Overflows are incredibly unrealistic.
              // `balance` and `numberMinted` have a maximum limit of 2**64.
              // `tokenId` has a maximum limit of 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
                  );
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance += quantity`.
                  // - `numberMinted += quantity`.
                  //
                  // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
                  // Mask `to` to the lower 160 bits, in case the upper bits somehow aren't clean.
                  uint256 toMasked = uint256(uint160(to)) & _BITMASK_ADDRESS;
                  if (toMasked == 0) _revert(MintToZeroAddress.selector);
                  uint256 end = startTokenId + quantity;
                  uint256 tokenId = startTokenId;
                  do {
                      assembly {
                          // Emit the `Transfer` event.
                          log4(
                              0, // Start of data (0, since no data).
                              0, // End of data (0, since no data).
                              _TRANSFER_EVENT_SIGNATURE, // Signature.
                              0, // `address(0)`.
                              toMasked, // `to`.
                              tokenId // `tokenId`.
                          )
                      }
                      // The `!=` check ensures that large values of `quantity`
                      // that overflows uint256 will make the loop run out of gas.
                  } while (++tokenId != end);
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = end;
              }
              _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * This function is intended for efficient minting only during contract creation.
           *
           * It emits only one {ConsecutiveTransfer} as defined in
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309),
           * instead of a sequence of {Transfer} event(s).
           *
           * Calling this function outside of contract creation WILL make your contract
           * non-compliant with the ERC721 standard.
           * For full ERC721 compliance, substituting ERC721 {Transfer} event(s) with the ERC2309
           * {ConsecutiveTransfer} event is only permissible during contract creation.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * Emits a {ConsecutiveTransfer} event.
           */
          function _mintERC2309(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              uint256 startTokenId = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
              if (to == address(0)) _revert(MintToZeroAddress.selector);
              if (quantity == 0) _revert(MintZeroQuantity.selector);
              if (quantity > _MAX_MINT_ERC2309_QUANTITY_LIMIT) _revert(MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit.selector);
              _beforeTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
              // Overflows are unrealistic due to the above check for `quantity` to be below the limit.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance += quantity`.
                  // - `numberMinted += quantity`.
                  //
                  // We can directly add to the `balance` and `numberMinted`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[to] += quantity * ((1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_MINTED) | 1);
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of minting.
                  // - `burned` to `false`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `quantity == 1`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[startTokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      to,
                      _nextInitializedFlag(quantity) | _nextExtraData(address(0), to, 0)
                  );
                  emit ConsecutiveTransfer(startTokenId, startTokenId + quantity - 1, address(0), to);
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex = startTokenId + quantity;
              }
              _afterTokenTransfers(address(0), to, startTokenId, quantity);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Safely mints `quantity` tokens and transfers them to `to`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called for each safe transfer.
           * - `quantity` must be greater than 0.
           *
           * See {_mint}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event for each mint.
           */
          function _safeMint(
              address to,
              uint256 quantity,
              bytes memory _data
          ) internal virtual {
              _mint(to, quantity);
              unchecked {
                  if (to.code.length != 0) {
                      uint256 end = ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex;
                      uint256 index = end - quantity;
                      do {
                          if (!_checkContractOnERC721Received(address(0), to, index++, _data)) {
                              _revert(TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer.selector);
                          }
                      } while (index < end);
                      // Reentrancy protection.
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex != end) _revert(bytes4(0));
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_safeMint(to, quantity, '')`.
           */
          function _safeMint(address to, uint256 quantity) internal virtual {
              _safeMint(to, quantity, '');
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                       APPROVAL OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_approve(to, tokenId, false)`.
           */
          function _approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _approve(to, tokenId, false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function _approve(
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bool approvalCheck
          ) internal virtual {
              address owner = ownerOf(tokenId);
              if (approvalCheck && _msgSenderERC721A() != owner)
                  if (!isApprovedForAll(owner, _msgSenderERC721A())) {
                      _revert(ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
                  }
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._tokenApprovals[tokenId].value = to;
              emit Approval(owner, to, tokenId);
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                        BURN OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `_burn(tokenId, false)`.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId) internal virtual {
              _burn(tokenId, false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Destroys `tokenId`.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is burned.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function _burn(uint256 tokenId, bool approvalCheck) internal virtual {
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked = _packedOwnershipOf(tokenId);
              address from = address(uint160(prevOwnershipPacked));
              (uint256 approvedAddressSlot, address approvedAddress) = _getApprovedSlotAndAddress(tokenId);
              if (approvalCheck) {
                  // The nested ifs save around 20+ gas over a compound boolean condition.
                  if (!_isSenderApprovedOrOwner(approvedAddress, from, _msgSenderERC721A()))
                      if (!isApprovedForAll(from, _msgSenderERC721A())) _revert(TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved.selector);
              }
              _beforeTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
              // Clear approvals from the previous owner.
              assembly {
                  if approvedAddress {
                      // This is equivalent to `delete _tokenApprovals[tokenId]`.
                      sstore(approvedAddressSlot, 0)
                  }
              }
              // Underflow of the sender's balance is impossible because we check for
              // ownership above and the recipient's balance can't realistically overflow.
              // Counter overflow is incredibly unrealistic as `tokenId` would have to be 2**256.
              unchecked {
                  // Updates:
                  // - `balance -= 1`.
                  // - `numberBurned += 1`.
                  //
                  // We can directly decrement the balance, and increment the number burned.
                  // This is equivalent to `packed -= 1; packed += 1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED;`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedAddressData[from] += (1 << _BITPOS_NUMBER_BURNED) - 1;
                  // Updates:
                  // - `address` to the last owner.
                  // - `startTimestamp` to the timestamp of burning.
                  // - `burned` to `true`.
                  // - `nextInitialized` to `true`.
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[tokenId] = _packOwnershipData(
                      from,
                      (_BITMASK_BURNED | _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED) | _nextExtraData(from, address(0), prevOwnershipPacked)
                  );
                  // If the next slot may not have been initialized (i.e. `nextInitialized == false`) .
                  if (prevOwnershipPacked & _BITMASK_NEXT_INITIALIZED == 0) {
                      uint256 nextTokenId = tokenId + 1;
                      // If the next slot's address is zero and not burned (i.e. packed value is zero).
                      if (ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] == 0) {
                          // If the next slot is within bounds.
                          if (nextTokenId != ERC721AStorage.layout()._currentIndex) {
                              // Initialize the next slot to maintain correctness for `ownerOf(tokenId + 1)`.
                              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[nextTokenId] = prevOwnershipPacked;
                          }
                      }
                  }
              }
              emit Transfer(from, address(0), tokenId);
              _afterTokenTransfers(from, address(0), tokenId, 1);
              // Overflow not possible, as _burnCounter cannot be exceed _currentIndex times.
              unchecked {
                  ERC721AStorage.layout()._burnCounter++;
              }
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                     EXTRA DATA OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Directly sets the extra data for the ownership data `index`.
           */
          function _setExtraDataAt(uint256 index, uint24 extraData) internal virtual {
              uint256 packed = ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index];
              if (packed == 0) _revert(OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData.selector);
              uint256 extraDataCasted;
              // Cast `extraData` with assembly to avoid redundant masking.
              assembly {
                  extraDataCasted := extraData
              }
              packed = (packed & _BITMASK_EXTRA_DATA_COMPLEMENT) | (extraDataCasted << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
              ERC721AStorage.layout()._packedOwnerships[index] = packed;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Called during each token transfer to set the 24bit `extraData` field.
           * Intended to be overridden by the cosumer contract.
           *
           * `previousExtraData` - the value of `extraData` before transfer.
           *
           * Calling conditions:
           *
           * - When `from` and `to` are both non-zero, `from`'s `tokenId` will be
           * transferred to `to`.
           * - When `from` is zero, `tokenId` will be minted for `to`.
           * - When `to` is zero, `tokenId` will be burned by `from`.
           * - `from` and `to` are never both zero.
           */
          function _extraData(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint24 previousExtraData
          ) internal view virtual returns (uint24) {}
          /**
           * @dev Returns the next extra data for the packed ownership data.
           * The returned result is shifted into position.
           */
          function _nextExtraData(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 prevOwnershipPacked
          ) private view returns (uint256) {
              uint24 extraData = uint24(prevOwnershipPacked >> _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA);
              return uint256(_extraData(from, to, extraData)) << _BITPOS_EXTRA_DATA;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                       OTHER OPERATIONS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the message sender (defaults to `msg.sender`).
           *
           * If you are writing GSN compatible contracts, you need to override this function.
           */
          function _msgSenderERC721A() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a uint256 to its ASCII string decimal representation.
           */
          function _toString(uint256 value) internal pure virtual returns (string memory str) {
              assembly {
                  // The maximum value of a uint256 contains 78 digits (1 byte per digit), but
                  // we allocate 0xa0 bytes to keep the free memory pointer 32-byte word aligned.
                  // We will need 1 word for the trailing zeros padding, 1 word for the length,
                  // and 3 words for a maximum of 78 digits. Total: 5 * 0x20 = 0xa0.
                  let m := add(mload(0x40), 0xa0)
                  // Update the free memory pointer to allocate.
                  mstore(0x40, m)
                  // Assign the `str` to the end.
                  str := sub(m, 0x20)
                  // Zeroize the slot after the string.
                  mstore(str, 0)
                  // Cache the end of the memory to calculate the length later.
                  let end := str
                  // We write the string from rightmost digit to leftmost digit.
                  // The following is essentially a do-while loop that also handles the zero case.
                  // prettier-ignore
                  for { let temp := value } 1 {} {
                      str := sub(str, 1)
                      // Write the character to the pointer.
                      // The ASCII index of the '0' character is 48.
                      mstore8(str, add(48, mod(temp, 10)))
                      // Keep dividing `temp` until zero.
                      temp := div(temp, 10)
                      // prettier-ignore
                      if iszero(temp) { break }
                  }
                  let length := sub(end, str)
                  // Move the pointer 32 bytes leftwards to make room for the length.
                  str := sub(str, 0x20)
                  // Store the length.
                  mstore(str, length)
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev For more efficient reverts.
           */
          function _revert(bytes4 errorSelector) internal pure {
              assembly {
                  mstore(0x00, errorSelector)
                  revert(0x00, 0x04)
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable diamond facet contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
       * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
       * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
       * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
       *
       * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
       * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
       *
       * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
       * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
       */
      import {ERC721A__InitializableStorage} from './ERC721A__InitializableStorage.sol';
      abstract contract ERC721A__Initializable {
          using ERC721A__InitializableStorage for ERC721A__InitializableStorage.Layout;
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initializer function from being invoked twice.
           */
          modifier initializerERC721A() {
              // If the contract is initializing we ignore whether _initialized is set in order to support multiple
              // inheritance patterns, but we only do this in the context of a constructor, because in other contexts the
              // contract may have been reentered.
              require(
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing
                      ? _isConstructor()
                      : !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized,
                  'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is already initialized'
              );
              bool isTopLevelCall = !ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = true;
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initialized = true;
              }
              _;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing = false;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
           * {initializer} modifier, directly or indirectly.
           */
          modifier onlyInitializingERC721A() {
              require(
                  ERC721A__InitializableStorage.layout()._initializing,
                  'ERC721A__Initializable: contract is not initializing'
              );
              _;
          }
          /// @dev Returns true if and only if the function is running in the constructor
          function _isConstructor() private view returns (bool) {
              // extcodesize checks the size of the code stored in an address, and
              // address returns the current address. Since the code is still not
              // deployed when running a constructor, any checks on its code size will
              // yield zero, making it an effective way to detect if a contract is
              // under construction or not.
              address self = address(this);
              uint256 cs;
              assembly {
                  cs := extcodesize(self)
              }
              return cs == 0;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is a base storage for the  initialization function for upgradeable diamond facet contracts
       **/
      library ERC721A__InitializableStorage {
          struct Layout {
              /*
               * Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
               */
              bool _initialized;
              /*
               * Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
               */
              bool _initializing;
          }
          bytes32 internal constant STORAGE_SLOT = keccak256('ERC721A.contracts.storage.initializable.facet');
          function layout() internal pure returns (Layout storage l) {
              bytes32 slot = STORAGE_SLOT;
              assembly {
                  l.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721A.
       */
      interface IERC721AUpgradeable {
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error ApprovalCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error ApprovalQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * Cannot query the balance for the zero address.
           */
          error BalanceQueryForZeroAddress();
          /**
           * Cannot mint to the zero address.
           */
          error MintToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The quantity of tokens minted must be more than zero.
           */
          error MintZeroQuantity();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error OwnerQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           */
          error TransferCallerNotOwnerNorApproved();
          /**
           * The token must be owned by `from`.
           */
          error TransferFromIncorrectOwner();
          /**
           * Cannot safely transfer to a contract that does not implement the
           * ERC721Receiver interface.
           */
          error TransferToNonERC721ReceiverImplementer();
          /**
           * Cannot transfer to the zero address.
           */
          error TransferToZeroAddress();
          /**
           * The token does not exist.
           */
          error URIQueryForNonexistentToken();
          /**
           * The `quantity` minted with ERC2309 exceeds the safety limit.
           */
          error MintERC2309QuantityExceedsLimit();
          /**
           * The `extraData` cannot be set on an unintialized ownership slot.
           */
          error OwnershipNotInitializedForExtraData();
          // =============================================================
          //                            STRUCTS
          // =============================================================
          struct TokenOwnership {
              // The address of the owner.
              address addr;
              // Stores the start time of ownership with minimal overhead for tokenomics.
              uint64 startTimestamp;
              // Whether the token has been burned.
              bool burned;
              // Arbitrary data similar to `startTimestamp` that can be set via {_extraData}.
              uint24 extraData;
          }
          // =============================================================
          //                         TOKEN COUNTERS
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the total number of tokens in existence.
           * Burned tokens will reduce the count.
           * To get the total number of tokens minted, please see {_totalMinted}.
           */
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC165
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * [EIP section](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified)
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                            IERC721
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `tokenId` token is transferred from `from` to `to`.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables `approved` to manage the `tokenId` token.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed approved, uint256 indexed tokenId);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `owner` enables or disables
           * (`approved`) `operator` to manage all of its assets.
           */
          event ApprovalForAll(address indexed owner, address indexed operator, bool approved);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the number of tokens in `owner`'s account.
           */
          function balanceOf(address owner) external view returns (uint256 balance);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the owner of the `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address owner);
          /**
           * @dev Safely transfers `tokenId` token from `from` to `to`,
           * checking first that contract recipients are aware of the ERC721 protocol
           * to prevent tokens from being forever locked.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must exist and be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be have been allowed to move
           * this token by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           * - If `to` refers to a smart contract, it must implement
           * {IERC721Receiver-onERC721Received}, which is called upon a safe transfer.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              bytes calldata data
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Equivalent to `safeTransferFrom(from, to, tokenId, '')`.
           */
          function safeTransferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Transfers `tokenId` from `from` to `to`.
           *
           * WARNING: Usage of this method is discouraged, use {safeTransferFrom}
           * whenever possible.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `from` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `to` cannot be the zero address.
           * - `tokenId` token must be owned by `from`.
           * - If the caller is not `from`, it must be approved to move this token
           * by either {approve} or {setApprovalForAll}.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId
          ) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Gives permission to `to` to transfer `tokenId` token to another account.
           * The approval is cleared when the token is transferred.
           *
           * Only a single account can be approved at a time, so approving the
           * zero address clears previous approvals.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The caller must own the token or be an approved operator.
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address to, uint256 tokenId) external payable;
          /**
           * @dev Approve or remove `operator` as an operator for the caller.
           * Operators can call {transferFrom} or {safeTransferFrom}
           * for any token owned by the caller.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - The `operator` cannot be the caller.
           *
           * Emits an {ApprovalForAll} event.
           */
          function setApprovalForAll(address operator, bool _approved) external;
          /**
           * @dev Returns the account approved for `tokenId` token.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `tokenId` must exist.
           */
          function getApproved(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address operator);
          /**
           * @dev Returns if the `operator` is allowed to manage all of the assets of `owner`.
           *
           * See {setApprovalForAll}.
           */
          function isApprovedForAll(address owner, address operator) external view returns (bool);
          // =============================================================
          //                        IERC721Metadata
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection name.
           */
          function name() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the token collection symbol.
           */
          function symbol() external view returns (string memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the Uniform Resource Identifier (URI) for `tokenId` token.
           */
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (string memory);
          // =============================================================
          //                           IERC2309
          // =============================================================
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when tokens in `fromTokenId` to `toTokenId`
           * (inclusive) is transferred from `from` to `to`, as defined in the
           * [ERC2309](https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2309) standard.
           *
           * See {_mintERC2309} for more details.
           */
          event ConsecutiveTransfer(uint256 indexed fromTokenId, uint256 toTokenId, address indexed from, address indexed to);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import './IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol';
      import '../ERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
      import '../ERC721A__Initializable.sol';
      /**
       * @title ERC721AQueryable.
       *
       * @dev ERC721A subclass with convenience query functions.
       */
      abstract contract ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is
          ERC721A__Initializable,
          ERC721AUpgradeable,
          IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable
      {
          function __ERC721AQueryable_init() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {
              __ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained();
          }
          function __ERC721AQueryable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializingERC721A {}
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
           *
           * - `addr = address(0)`
           * - `startTimestamp = 0`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = 0`
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is burned:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
           * - `burned = true`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
           *
           * Otherwise:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
           */
          function explicitOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId)
              public
              view
              virtual
              override
              returns (TokenOwnership memory ownership)
          {
              unchecked {
                  if (tokenId >= _startTokenId()) {
                      if (tokenId < _nextTokenId()) {
                          // If the `tokenId` is within bounds,
                          // scan backwards for the initialized ownership slot.
                          while (!_ownershipIsInitialized(tokenId)) --tokenId;
                          return _ownershipAt(tokenId);
                      }
                  }
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of `TokenOwnership` structs at `tokenIds` in order.
           * See {ERC721AQueryable-explicitOwnershipOf}
           */
          function explicitOwnershipsOf(uint256[] calldata tokenIds)
              external
              view
              virtual
              override
              returns (TokenOwnership[] memory)
          {
              TokenOwnership[] memory ownerships;
              uint256 i = tokenIds.length;
              assembly {
                  // Grab the free memory pointer.
                  ownerships := mload(0x40)
                  // Store the length.
                  mstore(ownerships, i)
                  // Allocate one word for the length,
                  // `tokenIds.length` words for the pointers.
                  i := shl(5, i) // Multiply `i` by 32.
                  mstore(0x40, add(add(ownerships, 0x20), i))
              }
              while (i != 0) {
                  uint256 tokenId;
                  assembly {
                      i := sub(i, 0x20)
                      tokenId := calldataload(add(tokenIds.offset, i))
                  }
                  TokenOwnership memory ownership = explicitOwnershipOf(tokenId);
                  assembly {
                      // Store the pointer of `ownership` in the `ownerships` array.
                      mstore(add(add(ownerships, 0x20), i), ownership)
                  }
              }
              return ownerships;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
           * in the range [`start`, `stop`)
           * (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
           *
           * This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
           * grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `start < stop`
           */
          function tokensOfOwnerIn(
              address owner,
              uint256 start,
              uint256 stop
          ) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
              return _tokensOfOwnerIn(owner, start, stop);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
           * It is meant to be called off-chain.
           *
           * See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
           * multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
           * an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
           */
          function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view virtual override returns (uint256[] memory) {
              uint256 start = _startTokenId();
              uint256 stop = _nextTokenId();
              uint256[] memory tokenIds;
              if (start != stop) tokenIds = _tokensOfOwnerIn(owner, start, stop);
              return tokenIds;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Helper function for returning an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * Note that this function is optimized for smaller bytecode size over runtime gas,
           * since it is meant to be called off-chain.
           */
          function _tokensOfOwnerIn(
              address owner,
              uint256 start,
              uint256 stop
          ) private view returns (uint256[] memory) {
              unchecked {
                  if (start >= stop) _revert(InvalidQueryRange.selector);
                  // Set `start = max(start, _startTokenId())`.
                  if (start < _startTokenId()) {
                      start = _startTokenId();
                  }
                  uint256 stopLimit = _nextTokenId();
                  // Set `stop = min(stop, stopLimit)`.
                  if (stop >= stopLimit) {
                      stop = stopLimit;
                  }
                  uint256[] memory tokenIds;
                  uint256 tokenIdsMaxLength = balanceOf(owner);
                  bool startLtStop = start < stop;
                  assembly {
                      // Set `tokenIdsMaxLength` to zero if `start` is less than `stop`.
                      tokenIdsMaxLength := mul(tokenIdsMaxLength, startLtStop)
                  }
                  if (tokenIdsMaxLength != 0) {
                      // Set `tokenIdsMaxLength = min(balanceOf(owner), stop - start)`,
                      // to cater for cases where `balanceOf(owner)` is too big.
                      if (stop - start <= tokenIdsMaxLength) {
                          tokenIdsMaxLength = stop - start;
                      }
                      assembly {
                          // Grab the free memory pointer.
                          tokenIds := mload(0x40)
                          // Allocate one word for the length, and `tokenIdsMaxLength` words
                          // for the data. `shl(5, x)` is equivalent to `mul(32, x)`.
                          mstore(0x40, add(tokenIds, shl(5, add(tokenIdsMaxLength, 1))))
                      }
                      // We need to call `explicitOwnershipOf(start)`,
                      // because the slot at `start` may not be initialized.
                      TokenOwnership memory ownership = explicitOwnershipOf(start);
                      address currOwnershipAddr;
                      // If the starting slot exists (i.e. not burned),
                      // initialize `currOwnershipAddr`.
                      // `ownership.address` will not be zero,
                      // as `start` is clamped to the valid token ID range.
                      if (!ownership.burned) {
                          currOwnershipAddr = ownership.addr;
                      }
                      uint256 tokenIdsIdx;
                      // Use a do-while, which is slightly more efficient for this case,
                      // as the array will at least contain one element.
                      do {
                          ownership = _ownershipAt(start);
                          assembly {
                              switch mload(add(ownership, 0x40))
                              // if `ownership.burned == false`.
                              case 0 {
                                  // if `ownership.addr != address(0)`.
                                  // The `addr` already has it's upper 96 bits clearned,
                                  // since it is written to memory with regular Solidity.
                                  if mload(ownership) {
                                      currOwnershipAddr := mload(ownership)
                                  }
                                  // if `currOwnershipAddr == owner`.
                                  // The `shl(96, x)` is to make the comparison agnostic to any
                                  // dirty upper 96 bits in `owner`.
                                  if iszero(shl(96, xor(currOwnershipAddr, owner))) {
                                      tokenIdsIdx := add(tokenIdsIdx, 1)
                                      mstore(add(tokenIds, shl(5, tokenIdsIdx)), start)
                                  }
                              }
                              // Otherwise, reset `currOwnershipAddr`.
                              // This handles the case of batch burned tokens
                              // (burned bit of first slot set, remaining slots left uninitialized).
                              default {
                                  currOwnershipAddr := 0
                              }
                              start := add(start, 1)
                          }
                      } while (!(start == stop || tokenIdsIdx == tokenIdsMaxLength));
                      // Store the length of the array.
                      assembly {
                          mstore(tokenIds, tokenIdsIdx)
                      }
                  }
                  return tokenIds;
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // ERC721A Contracts v4.2.3
      // Creator: Chiru Labs
      pragma solidity ^0.8.4;
      import '../IERC721AUpgradeable.sol';
      /**
       * @dev Interface of ERC721AQueryable.
       */
      interface IERC721AQueryableUpgradeable is IERC721AUpgradeable {
          /**
           * Invalid query range (`start` >= `stop`).
           */
          error InvalidQueryRange();
          /**
           * @dev Returns the `TokenOwnership` struct at `tokenId` without reverting.
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is out of bounds:
           *
           * - `addr = address(0)`
           * - `startTimestamp = 0`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = 0`
           *
           * If the `tokenId` is burned:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner before token was burned>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp when token was burned>`
           * - `burned = true`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data when token was burned>`
           *
           * Otherwise:
           *
           * - `addr = <Address of owner>`
           * - `startTimestamp = <Timestamp of start of ownership>`
           * - `burned = false`
           * - `extraData = <Extra data at start of ownership>`
           */
          function explicitOwnershipOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (TokenOwnership memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of `TokenOwnership` structs at `tokenIds` in order.
           * See {ERC721AQueryable-explicitOwnershipOf}
           */
          function explicitOwnershipsOf(uint256[] memory tokenIds) external view returns (TokenOwnership[] memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`,
           * in the range [`start`, `stop`)
           * (i.e. `start <= tokenId < stop`).
           *
           * This function allows for tokens to be queried if the collection
           * grows too big for a single call of {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwner}.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `start < stop`
           */
          function tokensOfOwnerIn(
              address owner,
              uint256 start,
              uint256 stop
          ) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
          /**
           * @dev Returns an array of token IDs owned by `owner`.
           *
           * This function scans the ownership mapping and is O(`totalSupply`) in complexity.
           * It is meant to be called off-chain.
           *
           * See {ERC721AQueryable-tokensOfOwnerIn} for splitting the scan into
           * multiple smaller scans if the collection is large enough to cause
           * an out-of-gas error (10K collections should be fine).
           */
          function tokensOfOwner(address owner) external view returns (uint256[] memory);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev ERC1822: Universal Upgradeable Proxy Standard (UUPS) documents a method for upgradeability through a simplified
       * proxy whose upgrades are fully controlled by the current implementation.
       */
      interface IERC1822Proxiable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns the storage slot that the proxiable contract assumes is being used to store the implementation
           * address.
           *
           * IMPORTANT: A proxy pointing at a proxiable contract should not be considered proxiable itself, because this risks
           * bricking a proxy that upgrades to it, by delegating to itself until out of gas. Thus it is critical that this
           * function revert if invoked through a proxy.
           */
          function proxiableUUID() external view returns (bytes32);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (proxy/ERC1967/ERC1967Upgrade.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
      import "../beacon/IBeacon.sol";
      import "../../interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol";
      import "../../utils/Address.sol";
      import "../../utils/StorageSlot.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This abstract contract provides getters and event emitting update functions for
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1967[EIP1967] slots.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       *
       * @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow delegatecall
       */
      abstract contract ERC1967Upgrade {
          // This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.rollback" subtracted by 1
          bytes32 private constant _ROLLBACK_SLOT = 0x4910fdfa16fed3260ed0e7147f7cc6da11a60208b5b9406d12a635614ffd9143;
          /**
           * @dev Storage slot with the address of the current implementation.
           * This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.implementation" subtracted by 1, and is
           * validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the implementation is upgraded.
           */
          event Upgraded(address indexed implementation);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current implementation address.
           */
          function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 implementation slot.
           */
          function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) private {
              require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeTo(address newImplementation) internal {
              _setImplementation(newImplementation);
              emit Upgraded(newImplementation);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade with additional setup call.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeToAndCall(
              address newImplementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              _upgradeTo(newImplementation);
              if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
                  Address.functionDelegateCall(newImplementation, data);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform implementation upgrade with security checks for UUPS proxies, and additional setup call.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeToAndCallUUPS(
              address newImplementation,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              // Upgrades from old implementations will perform a rollback test. This test requires the new
              // implementation to upgrade back to the old, non-ERC1822 compliant, implementation. Removing
              // this special case will break upgrade paths from old UUPS implementation to new ones.
              if (StorageSlot.getBooleanSlot(_ROLLBACK_SLOT).value) {
                  _setImplementation(newImplementation);
              } else {
                  try IERC1822Proxiable(newImplementation).proxiableUUID() returns (bytes32 slot) {
                      require(slot == _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT, "ERC1967Upgrade: unsupported proxiableUUID");
                  } catch {
                      revert("ERC1967Upgrade: new implementation is not UUPS");
                  }
                  _upgradeToAndCall(newImplementation, data, forceCall);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Storage slot with the admin of the contract.
           * This is the keccak-256 hash of "eip1967.proxy.admin" subtracted by 1, and is
           * validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _ADMIN_SLOT = 0xb53127684a568b3173ae13b9f8a6016e243e63b6e8ee1178d6a717850b5d6103;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the admin account has changed.
           */
          event AdminChanged(address previousAdmin, address newAdmin);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current admin.
           */
          function _getAdmin() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new address in the EIP1967 admin slot.
           */
          function _setAdmin(address newAdmin) private {
              require(newAdmin != address(0), "ERC1967: new admin is the zero address");
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_ADMIN_SLOT).value = newAdmin;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Changes the admin of the proxy.
           *
           * Emits an {AdminChanged} event.
           */
          function _changeAdmin(address newAdmin) internal {
              emit AdminChanged(_getAdmin(), newAdmin);
              _setAdmin(newAdmin);
          }
          /**
           * @dev The storage slot of the UpgradeableBeacon contract which defines the implementation for this proxy.
           * This is bytes32(uint256(keccak256('eip1967.proxy.beacon')) - 1)) and is validated in the constructor.
           */
          bytes32 internal constant _BEACON_SLOT = 0xa3f0ad74e5423aebfd80d3ef4346578335a9a72aeaee59ff6cb3582b35133d50;
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the beacon is upgraded.
           */
          event BeaconUpgraded(address indexed beacon);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the current beacon.
           */
          function _getBeacon() internal view returns (address) {
              return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Stores a new beacon in the EIP1967 beacon slot.
           */
          function _setBeacon(address newBeacon) private {
              require(Address.isContract(newBeacon), "ERC1967: new beacon is not a contract");
              require(
                  Address.isContract(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation()),
                  "ERC1967: beacon implementation is not a contract"
              );
              StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_BEACON_SLOT).value = newBeacon;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Perform beacon upgrade with additional setup call. Note: This upgrades the address of the beacon, it does
           * not upgrade the implementation contained in the beacon (see {UpgradeableBeacon-_setImplementation} for that).
           *
           * Emits a {BeaconUpgraded} event.
           */
          function _upgradeBeaconToAndCall(
              address newBeacon,
              bytes memory data,
              bool forceCall
          ) internal {
              _setBeacon(newBeacon);
              emit BeaconUpgraded(newBeacon);
              if (data.length > 0 || forceCall) {
                  Address.functionDelegateCall(IBeacon(newBeacon).implementation(), data);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (proxy/beacon/IBeacon.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev This is the interface that {BeaconProxy} expects of its beacon.
       */
      interface IBeacon {
          /**
           * @dev Must return an address that can be used as a delegate call target.
           *
           * {BeaconProxy} will check that this address is a contract.
           */
          function implementation() external view returns (address);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.5.0) (proxy/utils/UUPSUpgradeable.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../../interfaces/draft-IERC1822.sol";
      import "../ERC1967/ERC1967Upgrade.sol";
      /**
       * @dev An upgradeability mechanism designed for UUPS proxies. The functions included here can perform an upgrade of an
       * {ERC1967Proxy}, when this contract is set as the implementation behind such a proxy.
       *
       * A security mechanism ensures that an upgrade does not turn off upgradeability accidentally, although this risk is
       * reinstated if the upgrade retains upgradeability but removes the security mechanism, e.g. by replacing
       * `UUPSUpgradeable` with a custom implementation of upgrades.
       *
       * The {_authorizeUpgrade} function must be overridden to include access restriction to the upgrade mechanism.
       *
       * _Available since v4.1._
       */
      abstract contract UUPSUpgradeable is IERC1822Proxiable, ERC1967Upgrade {
          /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow state-variable-immutable state-variable-assignment
          address private immutable __self = address(this);
          /**
           * @dev Check that the execution is being performed through a delegatecall call and that the execution context is
           * a proxy contract with an implementation (as defined in ERC1967) pointing to self. This should only be the case
           * for UUPS and transparent proxies that are using the current contract as their implementation. Execution of a
           * function through ERC1167 minimal proxies (clones) would not normally pass this test, but is not guaranteed to
           * fail.
           */
          modifier onlyProxy() {
              require(address(this) != __self, "Function must be called through delegatecall");
              require(_getImplementation() == __self, "Function must be called through active proxy");
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Check that the execution is not being performed through a delegate call. This allows a function to be
           * callable on the implementing contract but not through proxies.
           */
          modifier notDelegated() {
              require(address(this) == __self, "UUPSUpgradeable: must not be called through delegatecall");
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Implementation of the ERC1822 {proxiableUUID} function. This returns the storage slot used by the
           * implementation. It is used to validate that the this implementation remains valid after an upgrade.
           *
           * IMPORTANT: A proxy pointing at a proxiable contract should not be considered proxiable itself, because this risks
           * bricking a proxy that upgrades to it, by delegating to itself until out of gas. Thus it is critical that this
           * function revert if invoked through a proxy. This is guaranteed by the `notDelegated` modifier.
           */
          function proxiableUUID() external view virtual override notDelegated returns (bytes32) {
              return _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Upgrade the implementation of the proxy to `newImplementation`.
           *
           * Calls {_authorizeUpgrade}.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function upgradeTo(address newImplementation) external virtual onlyProxy {
              _authorizeUpgrade(newImplementation);
              _upgradeToAndCallUUPS(newImplementation, new bytes(0), false);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Upgrade the implementation of the proxy to `newImplementation`, and subsequently execute the function call
           * encoded in `data`.
           *
           * Calls {_authorizeUpgrade}.
           *
           * Emits an {Upgraded} event.
           */
          function upgradeToAndCall(address newImplementation, bytes memory data) external payable virtual onlyProxy {
              _authorizeUpgrade(newImplementation);
              _upgradeToAndCallUUPS(newImplementation, data, true);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Function that should revert when `msg.sender` is not authorized to upgrade the contract. Called by
           * {upgradeTo} and {upgradeToAndCall}.
           *
           * Normally, this function will use an xref:access.adoc[access control] modifier such as {Ownable-onlyOwner}.
           *
           * ```solidity
           * function _authorizeUpgrade(address) internal override onlyOwner {}
           * ```
           */
          function _authorizeUpgrade(address newImplementation) internal virtual;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.6.0) (token/ERC20/IERC20.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC20 standard as defined in the EIP.
       */
      interface IERC20 {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `value` tokens are moved from one account (`from`) to
           * another (`to`).
           *
           * Note that `value` may be zero.
           */
          event Transfer(address indexed from, address indexed to, uint256 value);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when the allowance of a `spender` for an `owner` is set by
           * a call to {approve}. `value` is the new allowance.
           */
          event Approval(address indexed owner, address indexed spender, uint256 value);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the amount of tokens in existence.
           */
          function totalSupply() external view returns (uint256);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the amount of tokens owned by `account`.
           */
          function balanceOf(address account) external view returns (uint256);
          /**
           * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from the caller's account to `to`.
           *
           * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transfer(address to, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the remaining number of tokens that `spender` will be
           * allowed to spend on behalf of `owner` through {transferFrom}. This is
           * zero by default.
           *
           * This value changes when {approve} or {transferFrom} are called.
           */
          function allowance(address owner, address spender) external view returns (uint256);
          /**
           * @dev Sets `amount` as the allowance of `spender` over the caller's tokens.
           *
           * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
           *
           * IMPORTANT: Beware that changing an allowance with this method brings the risk
           * that someone may use both the old and the new allowance by unfortunate
           * transaction ordering. One possible solution to mitigate this race
           * condition is to first reduce the spender's allowance to 0 and set the
           * desired value afterwards:
           * https://github.com/ethereum/EIPs/issues/20#issuecomment-263524729
           *
           * Emits an {Approval} event.
           */
          function approve(address spender, uint256 amount) external returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Moves `amount` tokens from `from` to `to` using the
           * allowance mechanism. `amount` is then deducted from the caller's
           * allowance.
           *
           * Returns a boolean value indicating whether the operation succeeded.
           *
           * Emits a {Transfer} event.
           */
          function transferFrom(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 amount
          ) external returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library Address {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://diligence.consensys.net/posts/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCall(target, data, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: static call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionDelegateCall(target, data, "Address: low-level delegate call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a delegate call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.4._
           */
          function functionDelegateCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(isContract(target), "Address: delegate call to non-contract");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.delegatecall(data);
              return verifyCallResult(success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verifies that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
                  if (returndata.length > 0) {
                      // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                          revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                      }
                  } else {
                      revert(errorMessage);
                  }
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (utils/StorageSlot.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Library for reading and writing primitive types to specific storage slots.
       *
       * Storage slots are often used to avoid storage conflict when dealing with upgradeable contracts.
       * This library helps with reading and writing to such slots without the need for inline assembly.
       *
       * The functions in this library return Slot structs that contain a `value` member that can be used to read or write.
       *
       * Example usage to set ERC1967 implementation slot:
       * ```
       * contract ERC1967 {
       *     bytes32 internal constant _IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT = 0x360894a13ba1a3210667c828492db98dca3e2076cc3735a920a3ca505d382bbc;
       *
       *     function _getImplementation() internal view returns (address) {
       *         return StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value;
       *     }
       *
       *     function _setImplementation(address newImplementation) internal {
       *         require(Address.isContract(newImplementation), "ERC1967: new implementation is not a contract");
       *         StorageSlot.getAddressSlot(_IMPLEMENTATION_SLOT).value = newImplementation;
       *     }
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * _Available since v4.1 for `address`, `bool`, `bytes32`, and `uint256`._
       */
      library StorageSlot {
          struct AddressSlot {
              address value;
          }
          struct BooleanSlot {
              bool value;
          }
          struct Bytes32Slot {
              bytes32 value;
          }
          struct Uint256Slot {
              uint256 value;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `AddressSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getAddressSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (AddressSlot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `BooleanSlot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getBooleanSlot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (BooleanSlot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `Bytes32Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getBytes32Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Bytes32Slot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns an `Uint256Slot` with member `value` located at `slot`.
           */
          function getUint256Slot(bytes32 slot) internal pure returns (Uint256Slot storage r) {
              /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
              assembly {
                  r.slot := slot
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (access/AccessControl.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./IAccessControlUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../utils/StringsUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../utils/introspection/ERC165Upgradeable.sol";
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Contract module that allows children to implement role-based access
       * control mechanisms. This is a lightweight version that doesn't allow enumerating role
       * members except through off-chain means by accessing the contract event logs. Some
       * applications may benefit from on-chain enumerability, for those cases see
       * {AccessControlEnumerable}.
       *
       * Roles are referred to by their `bytes32` identifier. These should be exposed
       * in the external API and be unique. The best way to achieve this is by
       * using `public constant` hash digests:
       *
       * ```solidity
       * bytes32 public constant MY_ROLE = keccak256("MY_ROLE");
       * ```
       *
       * Roles can be used to represent a set of permissions. To restrict access to a
       * function call, use {hasRole}:
       *
       * ```solidity
       * function foo() public {
       *     require(hasRole(MY_ROLE, msg.sender));
       *     ...
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * Roles can be granted and revoked dynamically via the {grantRole} and
       * {revokeRole} functions. Each role has an associated admin role, and only
       * accounts that have a role's admin role can call {grantRole} and {revokeRole}.
       *
       * By default, the admin role for all roles is `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE`, which means
       * that only accounts with this role will be able to grant or revoke other
       * roles. More complex role relationships can be created by using
       * {_setRoleAdmin}.
       *
       * WARNING: The `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is also its own admin: it has permission to
       * grant and revoke this role. Extra precautions should be taken to secure
       * accounts that have been granted it.
       */
      abstract contract AccessControlUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable, IAccessControlUpgradeable, ERC165Upgradeable {
          function __AccessControl_init() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function __AccessControl_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          struct RoleData {
              mapping(address => bool) members;
              bytes32 adminRole;
          }
          mapping(bytes32 => RoleData) private _roles;
          bytes32 public constant DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE = 0x00;
          /**
           * @dev Modifier that checks that an account has a specific role. Reverts
           * with a standardized message including the required role.
           *
           * The format of the revert reason is given by the following regular expression:
           *
           *  /^AccessControl: account (0x[0-9a-f]{40}) is missing role (0x[0-9a-f]{64})$/
           *
           * _Available since v4.1._
           */
          modifier onlyRole(bytes32 role) {
              _checkRole(role);
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return interfaceId == type(IAccessControlUpgradeable).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           */
          function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return _roles[role].members[account];
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revert with a standard message if `_msgSender()` is missing `role`.
           * Overriding this function changes the behavior of the {onlyRole} modifier.
           *
           * Format of the revert message is described in {_checkRole}.
           *
           * _Available since v4.6._
           */
          function _checkRole(bytes32 role) internal view virtual {
              _checkRole(role, _msgSender());
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revert with a standard message if `account` is missing `role`.
           *
           * The format of the revert reason is given by the following regular expression:
           *
           *  /^AccessControl: account (0x[0-9a-f]{40}) is missing role (0x[0-9a-f]{64})$/
           */
          function _checkRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal view virtual {
              if (!hasRole(role, account)) {
                  revert(
                      string(
                          abi.encodePacked(
                              "AccessControl: account ",
                              StringsUpgradeable.toHexString(account),
                              " is missing role ",
                              StringsUpgradeable.toHexString(uint256(role), 32)
                          )
                      )
                  );
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
           * {revokeRole}.
           *
           * To change a role's admin, use {_setRoleAdmin}.
           */
          function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) public view virtual override returns (bytes32) {
              return _roles[role].adminRole;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleGranted} event.
           */
          function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override onlyRole(getRoleAdmin(role)) {
              _grantRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleRevoked} event.
           */
          function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override onlyRole(getRoleAdmin(role)) {
              _revokeRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
           *
           * Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
           * purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
           * if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
           *
           * If the calling account had been revoked `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must be `account`.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleRevoked} event.
           */
          function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) public virtual override {
              require(account == _msgSender(), "AccessControl: can only renounce roles for self");
              _revokeRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
           * event. Note that unlike {grantRole}, this function doesn't perform any
           * checks on the calling account.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleGranted} event.
           *
           * [WARNING]
           * ====
           * This function should only be called from the constructor when setting
           * up the initial roles for the system.
           *
           * Using this function in any other way is effectively circumventing the admin
           * system imposed by {AccessControl}.
           * ====
           *
           * NOTE: This function is deprecated in favor of {_grantRole}.
           */
          function _setupRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              _grantRole(role, account);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Sets `adminRole` as ``role``'s admin role.
           *
           * Emits a {RoleAdminChanged} event.
           */
          function _setRoleAdmin(bytes32 role, bytes32 adminRole) internal virtual {
              bytes32 previousAdminRole = getRoleAdmin(role);
              _roles[role].adminRole = adminRole;
              emit RoleAdminChanged(role, previousAdminRole, adminRole);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * Internal function without access restriction.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleGranted} event.
           */
          function _grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              if (!hasRole(role, account)) {
                  _roles[role].members[account] = true;
                  emit RoleGranted(role, account, _msgSender());
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
           *
           * Internal function without access restriction.
           *
           * May emit a {RoleRevoked} event.
           */
          function _revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) internal virtual {
              if (hasRole(role, account)) {
                  _roles[role].members[account] = false;
                  emit RoleRevoked(role, account, _msgSender());
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[49] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (access/IAccessControl.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev External interface of AccessControl declared to support ERC165 detection.
       */
      interface IAccessControlUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `newAdminRole` is set as ``role``'s admin role, replacing `previousAdminRole`
           *
           * `DEFAULT_ADMIN_ROLE` is the starting admin for all roles, despite
           * {RoleAdminChanged} not being emitted signaling this.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          event RoleAdminChanged(bytes32 indexed role, bytes32 indexed previousAdminRole, bytes32 indexed newAdminRole);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` is granted `role`.
           *
           * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call, an admin role
           * bearer except when using {AccessControl-_setupRole}.
           */
          event RoleGranted(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
          /**
           * @dev Emitted when `account` is revoked `role`.
           *
           * `sender` is the account that originated the contract call:
           *   - if using `revokeRole`, it is the admin role bearer
           *   - if using `renounceRole`, it is the role bearer (i.e. `account`)
           */
          event RoleRevoked(bytes32 indexed role, address indexed account, address indexed sender);
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if `account` has been granted `role`.
           */
          function hasRole(bytes32 role, address account) external view returns (bool);
          /**
           * @dev Returns the admin role that controls `role`. See {grantRole} and
           * {revokeRole}.
           *
           * To change a role's admin, use {AccessControl-_setRoleAdmin}.
           */
          function getRoleAdmin(bytes32 role) external view returns (bytes32);
          /**
           * @dev Grants `role` to `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had not been already granted `role`, emits a {RoleGranted}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           */
          function grantRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from `account`.
           *
           * If `account` had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked} event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must have ``role``'s admin role.
           */
          function revokeRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
          /**
           * @dev Revokes `role` from the calling account.
           *
           * Roles are often managed via {grantRole} and {revokeRole}: this function's
           * purpose is to provide a mechanism for accounts to lose their privileges
           * if they are compromised (such as when a trusted device is misplaced).
           *
           * If the calling account had been granted `role`, emits a {RoleRevoked}
           * event.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the caller must be `account`.
           */
          function renounceRole(bytes32 role, address account) external;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.7.0) (access/Ownable.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../utils/ContextUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Contract module which provides a basic access control mechanism, where
       * there is an account (an owner) that can be granted exclusive access to
       * specific functions.
       *
       * By default, the owner account will be the one that deploys the contract. This
       * can later be changed with {transferOwnership}.
       *
       * This module is used through inheritance. It will make available the modifier
       * `onlyOwner`, which can be applied to your functions to restrict their use to
       * the owner.
       */
      abstract contract OwnableUpgradeable is Initializable, ContextUpgradeable {
          address private _owner;
          event OwnershipTransferred(address indexed previousOwner, address indexed newOwner);
          /**
           * @dev Initializes the contract setting the deployer as the initial owner.
           */
          function __Ownable_init() internal onlyInitializing {
              __Ownable_init_unchained();
          }
          function __Ownable_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
              _transferOwnership(_msgSender());
          }
          /**
           * @dev Throws if called by any account other than the owner.
           */
          modifier onlyOwner() {
              _checkOwner();
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the address of the current owner.
           */
          function owner() public view virtual returns (address) {
              return _owner;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Throws if the sender is not the owner.
           */
          function _checkOwner() internal view virtual {
              require(owner() == _msgSender(), "Ownable: caller is not the owner");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Leaves the contract without owner. It will not be possible to call
           * `onlyOwner` functions anymore. Can only be called by the current owner.
           *
           * NOTE: Renouncing ownership will leave the contract without an owner,
           * thereby removing any functionality that is only available to the owner.
           */
          function renounceOwnership() public virtual onlyOwner {
              _transferOwnership(address(0));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
           * Can only be called by the current owner.
           */
          function transferOwnership(address newOwner) public virtual onlyOwner {
              require(newOwner != address(0), "Ownable: new owner is the zero address");
              _transferOwnership(newOwner);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Transfers ownership of the contract to a new account (`newOwner`).
           * Internal function without access restriction.
           */
          function _transferOwnership(address newOwner) internal virtual {
              address oldOwner = _owner;
              _owner = newOwner;
              emit OwnershipTransferred(oldOwner, newOwner);
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[49] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (proxy/utils/Initializable.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.2;
      import "../../utils/AddressUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev This is a base contract to aid in writing upgradeable contracts, or any kind of contract that will be deployed
       * behind a proxy. Since proxied contracts do not make use of a constructor, it's common to move constructor logic to an
       * external initializer function, usually called `initialize`. It then becomes necessary to protect this initializer
       * function so it can only be called once. The {initializer} modifier provided by this contract will have this effect.
       *
       * The initialization functions use a version number. Once a version number is used, it is consumed and cannot be
       * reused. This mechanism prevents re-execution of each "step" but allows the creation of new initialization steps in
       * case an upgrade adds a module that needs to be initialized.
       *
       * For example:
       *
       * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
       * ```solidity
       * contract MyToken is ERC20Upgradeable {
       *     function initialize() initializer public {
       *         __ERC20_init("MyToken", "MTK");
       *     }
       * }
       *
       * contract MyTokenV2 is MyToken, ERC20PermitUpgradeable {
       *     function initializeV2() reinitializer(2) public {
       *         __ERC20Permit_init("MyToken");
       *     }
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * TIP: To avoid leaving the proxy in an uninitialized state, the initializer function should be called as early as
       * possible by providing the encoded function call as the `_data` argument to {ERC1967Proxy-constructor}.
       *
       * CAUTION: When used with inheritance, manual care must be taken to not invoke a parent initializer twice, or to ensure
       * that all initializers are idempotent. This is not verified automatically as constructors are by Solidity.
       *
       * [CAUTION]
       * ====
       * Avoid leaving a contract uninitialized.
       *
       * An uninitialized contract can be taken over by an attacker. This applies to both a proxy and its implementation
       * contract, which may impact the proxy. To prevent the implementation contract from being used, you should invoke
       * the {_disableInitializers} function in the constructor to automatically lock it when it is deployed:
       *
       * [.hljs-theme-light.nopadding]
       * ```
       * /// @custom:oz-upgrades-unsafe-allow constructor
       * constructor() {
       *     _disableInitializers();
       * }
       * ```
       * ====
       */
      abstract contract Initializable {
          /**
           * @dev Indicates that the contract has been initialized.
           * @custom:oz-retyped-from bool
           */
          uint8 private _initialized;
          /**
           * @dev Indicates that the contract is in the process of being initialized.
           */
          bool private _initializing;
          /**
           * @dev Triggered when the contract has been initialized or reinitialized.
           */
          event Initialized(uint8 version);
          /**
           * @dev A modifier that defines a protected initializer function that can be invoked at most once. In its scope,
           * `onlyInitializing` functions can be used to initialize parent contracts.
           *
           * Similar to `reinitializer(1)`, except that functions marked with `initializer` can be nested in the context of a
           * constructor.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event.
           */
          modifier initializer() {
              bool isTopLevelCall = !_initializing;
              require(
                  (isTopLevelCall && _initialized < 1) || (!AddressUpgradeable.isContract(address(this)) && _initialized == 1),
                  "Initializable: contract is already initialized"
              );
              _initialized = 1;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  _initializing = true;
              }
              _;
              if (isTopLevelCall) {
                  _initializing = false;
                  emit Initialized(1);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev A modifier that defines a protected reinitializer function that can be invoked at most once, and only if the
           * contract hasn't been initialized to a greater version before. In its scope, `onlyInitializing` functions can be
           * used to initialize parent contracts.
           *
           * A reinitializer may be used after the original initialization step. This is essential to configure modules that
           * are added through upgrades and that require initialization.
           *
           * When `version` is 1, this modifier is similar to `initializer`, except that functions marked with `reinitializer`
           * cannot be nested. If one is invoked in the context of another, execution will revert.
           *
           * Note that versions can jump in increments greater than 1; this implies that if multiple reinitializers coexist in
           * a contract, executing them in the right order is up to the developer or operator.
           *
           * WARNING: setting the version to 255 will prevent any future reinitialization.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event.
           */
          modifier reinitializer(uint8 version) {
              require(!_initializing && _initialized < version, "Initializable: contract is already initialized");
              _initialized = version;
              _initializing = true;
              _;
              _initializing = false;
              emit Initialized(version);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Modifier to protect an initialization function so that it can only be invoked by functions with the
           * {initializer} and {reinitializer} modifiers, directly or indirectly.
           */
          modifier onlyInitializing() {
              require(_initializing, "Initializable: contract is not initializing");
              _;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Locks the contract, preventing any future reinitialization. This cannot be part of an initializer call.
           * Calling this in the constructor of a contract will prevent that contract from being initialized or reinitialized
           * to any version. It is recommended to use this to lock implementation contracts that are designed to be called
           * through proxies.
           *
           * Emits an {Initialized} event the first time it is successfully executed.
           */
          function _disableInitializers() internal virtual {
              require(!_initializing, "Initializable: contract is initializing");
              if (_initialized != type(uint8).max) {
                  _initialized = type(uint8).max;
                  emit Initialized(type(uint8).max);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the highest version that has been initialized. See {reinitializer}.
           */
          function _getInitializedVersion() internal view returns (uint8) {
              return _initialized;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns `true` if the contract is currently initializing. See {onlyInitializing}.
           */
          function _isInitializing() internal view returns (bool) {
              return _initializing;
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (security/ReentrancyGuard.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Contract module that helps prevent reentrant calls to a function.
       *
       * Inheriting from `ReentrancyGuard` will make the {nonReentrant} modifier
       * available, which can be applied to functions to make sure there are no nested
       * (reentrant) calls to them.
       *
       * Note that because there is a single `nonReentrant` guard, functions marked as
       * `nonReentrant` may not call one another. This can be worked around by making
       * those functions `private`, and then adding `external` `nonReentrant` entry
       * points to them.
       *
       * TIP: If you would like to learn more about reentrancy and alternative ways
       * to protect against it, check out our blog post
       * https://blog.openzeppelin.com/reentrancy-after-istanbul/[Reentrancy After Istanbul].
       */
      abstract contract ReentrancyGuardUpgradeable is Initializable {
          // Booleans are more expensive than uint256 or any type that takes up a full
          // word because each write operation emits an extra SLOAD to first read the
          // slot's contents, replace the bits taken up by the boolean, and then write
          // back. This is the compiler's defense against contract upgrades and
          // pointer aliasing, and it cannot be disabled.
          // The values being non-zero value makes deployment a bit more expensive,
          // but in exchange the refund on every call to nonReentrant will be lower in
          // amount. Since refunds are capped to a percentage of the total
          // transaction's gas, it is best to keep them low in cases like this one, to
          // increase the likelihood of the full refund coming into effect.
          uint256 private constant _NOT_ENTERED = 1;
          uint256 private constant _ENTERED = 2;
          uint256 private _status;
          function __ReentrancyGuard_init() internal onlyInitializing {
              __ReentrancyGuard_init_unchained();
          }
          function __ReentrancyGuard_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
              _status = _NOT_ENTERED;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Prevents a contract from calling itself, directly or indirectly.
           * Calling a `nonReentrant` function from another `nonReentrant`
           * function is not supported. It is possible to prevent this from happening
           * by making the `nonReentrant` function external, and making it call a
           * `private` function that does the actual work.
           */
          modifier nonReentrant() {
              _nonReentrantBefore();
              _;
              _nonReentrantAfter();
          }
          function _nonReentrantBefore() private {
              // On the first call to nonReentrant, _status will be _NOT_ENTERED
              require(_status != _ENTERED, "ReentrancyGuard: reentrant call");
              // Any calls to nonReentrant after this point will fail
              _status = _ENTERED;
          }
          function _nonReentrantAfter() private {
              // By storing the original value once again, a refund is triggered (see
              // https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-2200)
              _status = _NOT_ENTERED;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if the reentrancy guard is currently set to "entered", which indicates there is a
           * `nonReentrant` function in the call stack.
           */
          function _reentrancyGuardEntered() internal view returns (bool) {
              return _status == _ENTERED;
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[49] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Address.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.1;
      /**
       * @dev Collection of functions related to the address type
       */
      library AddressUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if `account` is a contract.
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * It is unsafe to assume that an address for which this function returns
           * false is an externally-owned account (EOA) and not a contract.
           *
           * Among others, `isContract` will return false for the following
           * types of addresses:
           *
           *  - an externally-owned account
           *  - a contract in construction
           *  - an address where a contract will be created
           *  - an address where a contract lived, but was destroyed
           *
           * Furthermore, `isContract` will also return true if the target contract within
           * the same transaction is already scheduled for destruction by `SELFDESTRUCT`,
           * which only has an effect at the end of a transaction.
           * ====
           *
           * [IMPORTANT]
           * ====
           * You shouldn't rely on `isContract` to protect against flash loan attacks!
           *
           * Preventing calls from contracts is highly discouraged. It breaks composability, breaks support for smart wallets
           * like Gnosis Safe, and does not provide security since it can be circumvented by calling from a contract
           * constructor.
           * ====
           */
          function isContract(address account) internal view returns (bool) {
              // This method relies on extcodesize/address.code.length, which returns 0
              // for contracts in construction, since the code is only stored at the end
              // of the constructor execution.
              return account.code.length > 0;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Replacement for Solidity's `transfer`: sends `amount` wei to
           * `recipient`, forwarding all available gas and reverting on errors.
           *
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-1884[EIP1884] increases the gas cost
           * of certain opcodes, possibly making contracts go over the 2300 gas limit
           * imposed by `transfer`, making them unable to receive funds via
           * `transfer`. {sendValue} removes this limitation.
           *
           * https://consensys.net/diligence/blog/2019/09/stop-using-soliditys-transfer-now/[Learn more].
           *
           * IMPORTANT: because control is transferred to `recipient`, care must be
           * taken to not create reentrancy vulnerabilities. Consider using
           * {ReentrancyGuard} or the
           * https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/v0.5.11/security-considerations.html#use-the-checks-effects-interactions-pattern[checks-effects-interactions pattern].
           */
          function sendValue(address payable recipient, uint256 amount) internal {
              require(address(this).balance >= amount, "Address: insufficient balance");
              (bool success, ) = recipient.call{value: amount}("");
              require(success, "Address: unable to send value, recipient may have reverted");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Performs a Solidity function call using a low level `call`. A
           * plain `call` is an unsafe replacement for a function call: use this
           * function instead.
           *
           * If `target` reverts with a revert reason, it is bubbled up by this
           * function (like regular Solidity function calls).
           *
           * Returns the raw returned data. To convert to the expected return value,
           * use https://solidity.readthedocs.io/en/latest/units-and-global-variables.html?highlight=abi.decode#abi-encoding-and-decoding-functions[`abi.decode`].
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - `target` must be a contract.
           * - calling `target` with `data` must not revert.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, "Address: low-level call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`], but with
           * `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, 0, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but also transferring `value` wei to `target`.
           *
           * Requirements:
           *
           * - the calling contract must have an ETH balance of at least `value`.
           * - the called Solidity function must be `payable`.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(address target, bytes memory data, uint256 value) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionCallWithValue(target, data, value, "Address: low-level call with value failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCallWithValue-address-bytes-uint256-}[`functionCallWithValue`], but
           * with `errorMessage` as a fallback revert reason when `target` reverts.
           *
           * _Available since v3.1._
           */
          function functionCallWithValue(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              uint256 value,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal returns (bytes memory) {
              require(address(this).balance >= value, "Address: insufficient balance for call");
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.call{value: value}(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(address target, bytes memory data) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              return functionStaticCall(target, data, "Address: low-level static call failed");
          }
          /**
           * @dev Same as {xref-Address-functionCall-address-bytes-string-}[`functionCall`],
           * but performing a static call.
           *
           * _Available since v3.3._
           */
          function functionStaticCall(
              address target,
              bytes memory data,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              (bool success, bytes memory returndata) = target.staticcall(data);
              return verifyCallResultFromTarget(target, success, returndata, errorMessage);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call to smart-contract was successful, and revert (either by bubbling
           * the revert reason or using the provided one) in case of unsuccessful call or if target was not a contract.
           *
           * _Available since v4.8._
           */
          function verifyCallResultFromTarget(
              address target,
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal view returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  if (returndata.length == 0) {
                      // only check isContract if the call was successful and the return data is empty
                      // otherwise we already know that it was a contract
                      require(isContract(target), "Address: call to non-contract");
                  }
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Tool to verify that a low level call was successful, and revert if it wasn't, either by bubbling the
           * revert reason or using the provided one.
           *
           * _Available since v4.3._
           */
          function verifyCallResult(
              bool success,
              bytes memory returndata,
              string memory errorMessage
          ) internal pure returns (bytes memory) {
              if (success) {
                  return returndata;
              } else {
                  _revert(returndata, errorMessage);
              }
          }
          function _revert(bytes memory returndata, string memory errorMessage) private pure {
              // Look for revert reason and bubble it up if present
              if (returndata.length > 0) {
                  // The easiest way to bubble the revert reason is using memory via assembly
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      let returndata_size := mload(returndata)
                      revert(add(32, returndata), returndata_size)
                  }
              } else {
                  revert(errorMessage);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/Context.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Provides information about the current execution context, including the
       * sender of the transaction and its data. While these are generally available
       * via msg.sender and msg.data, they should not be accessed in such a direct
       * manner, since when dealing with meta-transactions the account sending and
       * paying for execution may not be the actual sender (as far as an application
       * is concerned).
       *
       * This contract is only required for intermediate, library-like contracts.
       */
      abstract contract ContextUpgradeable is Initializable {
          function __Context_init() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function __Context_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function _msgSender() internal view virtual returns (address) {
              return msg.sender;
          }
          function _msgData() internal view virtual returns (bytes calldata) {
              return msg.data;
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[50] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/Strings.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./math/MathUpgradeable.sol";
      import "./math/SignedMathUpgradeable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev String operations.
       */
      library StringsUpgradeable {
          bytes16 private constant _SYMBOLS = "0123456789abcdef";
          uint8 private constant _ADDRESS_LENGTH = 20;
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 length = MathUpgradeable.log10(value) + 1;
                  string memory buffer = new string(length);
                  uint256 ptr;
                  /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                  assembly {
                      ptr := add(buffer, add(32, length))
                  }
                  while (true) {
                      ptr--;
                      /// @solidity memory-safe-assembly
                      assembly {
                          mstore8(ptr, byte(mod(value, 10), _SYMBOLS))
                      }
                      value /= 10;
                      if (value == 0) break;
                  }
                  return buffer;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `int256` to its ASCII `string` decimal representation.
           */
          function toString(int256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return string(abi.encodePacked(value < 0 ? "-" : "", toString(SignedMathUpgradeable.abs(value))));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              unchecked {
                  return toHexString(value, MathUpgradeable.log256(value) + 1);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts a `uint256` to its ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation with fixed length.
           */
          function toHexString(uint256 value, uint256 length) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              bytes memory buffer = new bytes(2 * length + 2);
              buffer[0] = "0";
              buffer[1] = "x";
              for (uint256 i = 2 * length + 1; i > 1; --i) {
                  buffer[i] = _SYMBOLS[value & 0xf];
                  value >>= 4;
              }
              require(value == 0, "Strings: hex length insufficient");
              return string(buffer);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Converts an `address` with fixed length of 20 bytes to its not checksummed ASCII `string` hexadecimal representation.
           */
          function toHexString(address addr) internal pure returns (string memory) {
              return toHexString(uint256(uint160(addr)), _ADDRESS_LENGTH);
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if the two strings are equal.
           */
          function equal(string memory a, string memory b) internal pure returns (bool) {
              return keccak256(bytes(a)) == keccak256(bytes(b));
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/ERC165.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      import "./IERC165Upgradeable.sol";
      import "../../proxy/utils/Initializable.sol";
      /**
       * @dev Implementation of the {IERC165} interface.
       *
       * Contracts that want to implement ERC165 should inherit from this contract and override {supportsInterface} to check
       * for the additional interface id that will be supported. For example:
       *
       * ```solidity
       * function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
       *     return interfaceId == type(MyInterface).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
       * }
       * ```
       *
       * Alternatively, {ERC165Storage} provides an easier to use but more expensive implementation.
       */
      abstract contract ERC165Upgradeable is Initializable, IERC165Upgradeable {
          function __ERC165_init() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          function __ERC165_init_unchained() internal onlyInitializing {
          }
          /**
           * @dev See {IERC165-supportsInterface}.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override returns (bool) {
              return interfaceId == type(IERC165Upgradeable).interfaceId;
          }
          /**
           * @dev This empty reserved space is put in place to allow future versions to add new
           * variables without shifting down storage in the inheritance chain.
           * See https://docs.openzeppelin.com/contracts/4.x/upgradeable#storage_gaps
           */
          uint256[50] private __gap;
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts v4.4.1 (utils/introspection/IERC165.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Interface of the ERC165 standard, as defined in the
       * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165[EIP].
       *
       * Implementers can declare support of contract interfaces, which can then be
       * queried by others ({ERC165Checker}).
       *
       * For an implementation, see {ERC165}.
       */
      interface IERC165Upgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns true if this contract implements the interface defined by
           * `interfaceId`. See the corresponding
           * https://eips.ethereum.org/EIPS/eip-165#how-interfaces-are-identified[EIP section]
           * to learn more about how these ids are created.
           *
           * This function call must use less than 30 000 gas.
           */
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) external view returns (bool);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/math/Math.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Standard math utilities missing in the Solidity language.
       */
      library MathUpgradeable {
          enum Rounding {
              Down, // Toward negative infinity
              Up, // Toward infinity
              Zero // Toward zero
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the largest of two numbers.
           */
          function max(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a > b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the smallest of two numbers.
           */
          function min(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the average of two numbers. The result is rounded towards
           * zero.
           */
          function average(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              // (a + b) / 2 can overflow.
              return (a & b) + (a ^ b) / 2;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the ceiling of the division of two numbers.
           *
           * This differs from standard division with `/` in that it rounds up instead
           * of rounding down.
           */
          function ceilDiv(uint256 a, uint256 b) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              // (a + b - 1) / b can overflow on addition, so we distribute.
              return a == 0 ? 0 : (a - 1) / b + 1;
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates floor(x * y / denominator) with full precision. Throws if result overflows a uint256 or denominator == 0
           * @dev Original credit to Remco Bloemen under MIT license (https://xn--2-umb.com/21/muldiv)
           * with further edits by Uniswap Labs also under MIT license.
           */
          function mulDiv(uint256 x, uint256 y, uint256 denominator) internal pure returns (uint256 result) {
              unchecked {
                  // 512-bit multiply [prod1 prod0] = x * y. Compute the product mod 2^256 and mod 2^256 - 1, then use
                  // use the Chinese Remainder Theorem to reconstruct the 512 bit result. The result is stored in two 256
                  // variables such that product = prod1 * 2^256 + prod0.
                  uint256 prod0; // Least significant 256 bits of the product
                  uint256 prod1; // Most significant 256 bits of the product
                  assembly {
                      let mm := mulmod(x, y, not(0))
                      prod0 := mul(x, y)
                      prod1 := sub(sub(mm, prod0), lt(mm, prod0))
                  }
                  // Handle non-overflow cases, 256 by 256 division.
                  if (prod1 == 0) {
                      return prod0 / denominator;
                  }
                  // Make sure the result is less than 2^256. Also prevents denominator == 0.
                  require(denominator > prod1, "Math: mulDiv overflow");
                  ///////////////////////////////////////////////
                  // 512 by 256 division.
                  ///////////////////////////////////////////////
                  // Make division exact by subtracting the remainder from [prod1 prod0].
                  uint256 remainder;
                  assembly {
                      // Compute remainder using mulmod.
                      remainder := mulmod(x, y, denominator)
                      // Subtract 256 bit number from 512 bit number.
                      prod1 := sub(prod1, gt(remainder, prod0))
                      prod0 := sub(prod0, remainder)
                  }
                  // Factor powers of two out of denominator and compute largest power of two divisor of denominator. Always >= 1.
                  // See https://cs.stackexchange.com/q/138556/92363.
                  // Does not overflow because the denominator cannot be zero at this stage in the function.
                  uint256 twos = denominator & (~denominator + 1);
                  assembly {
                      // Divide denominator by twos.
                      denominator := div(denominator, twos)
                      // Divide [prod1 prod0] by twos.
                      prod0 := div(prod0, twos)
                      // Flip twos such that it is 2^256 / twos. If twos is zero, then it becomes one.
                      twos := add(div(sub(0, twos), twos), 1)
                  }
                  // Shift in bits from prod1 into prod0.
                  prod0 |= prod1 * twos;
                  // Invert denominator mod 2^256. Now that denominator is an odd number, it has an inverse modulo 2^256 such
                  // that denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^256. Compute the inverse by starting with a seed that is correct for
                  // four bits. That is, denominator * inv = 1 mod 2^4.
                  uint256 inverse = (3 * denominator) ^ 2;
                  // Use the Newton-Raphson iteration to improve the precision. Thanks to Hensel's lifting lemma, this also works
                  // in modular arithmetic, doubling the correct bits in each step.
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^8
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^16
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^32
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^64
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^128
                  inverse *= 2 - denominator * inverse; // inverse mod 2^256
                  // Because the division is now exact we can divide by multiplying with the modular inverse of denominator.
                  // This will give us the correct result modulo 2^256. Since the preconditions guarantee that the outcome is
                  // less than 2^256, this is the final result. We don't need to compute the high bits of the result and prod1
                  // is no longer required.
                  result = prod0 * inverse;
                  return result;
              }
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates x * y / denominator with full precision, following the selected rounding direction.
           */
          function mulDiv(uint256 x, uint256 y, uint256 denominator, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = mulDiv(x, y, denominator);
              if (rounding == Rounding.Up && mulmod(x, y, denominator) > 0) {
                  result += 1;
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the square root of a number. If the number is not a perfect square, the value is rounded down.
           *
           * Inspired by Henry S. Warren, Jr.'s "Hacker's Delight" (Chapter 11).
           */
          function sqrt(uint256 a) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              if (a == 0) {
                  return 0;
              }
              // For our first guess, we get the biggest power of 2 which is smaller than the square root of the target.
              //
              // We know that the "msb" (most significant bit) of our target number `a` is a power of 2 such that we have
              // `msb(a) <= a < 2*msb(a)`. This value can be written `msb(a)=2**k` with `k=log2(a)`.
              //
              // This can be rewritten `2**log2(a) <= a < 2**(log2(a) + 1)`
              // → `sqrt(2**k) <= sqrt(a) < sqrt(2**(k+1))`
              // → `2**(k/2) <= sqrt(a) < 2**((k+1)/2) <= 2**(k/2 + 1)`
              //
              // Consequently, `2**(log2(a) / 2)` is a good first approximation of `sqrt(a)` with at least 1 correct bit.
              uint256 result = 1 << (log2(a) >> 1);
              // At this point `result` is an estimation with one bit of precision. We know the true value is a uint128,
              // since it is the square root of a uint256. Newton's method converges quadratically (precision doubles at
              // every iteration). We thus need at most 7 iteration to turn our partial result with one bit of precision
              // into the expected uint128 result.
              unchecked {
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  result = (result + a / result) >> 1;
                  return min(result, a / result);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @notice Calculates sqrt(a), following the selected rounding direction.
           */
          function sqrt(uint256 a, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = sqrt(a);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && result * result < a ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 2, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log2(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >> 128 > 0) {
                      value >>= 128;
                      result += 128;
                  }
                  if (value >> 64 > 0) {
                      value >>= 64;
                      result += 64;
                  }
                  if (value >> 32 > 0) {
                      value >>= 32;
                      result += 32;
                  }
                  if (value >> 16 > 0) {
                      value >>= 16;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >> 8 > 0) {
                      value >>= 8;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >> 4 > 0) {
                      value >>= 4;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >> 2 > 0) {
                      value >>= 2;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >> 1 > 0) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 2, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log2(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log2(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << result < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log10(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >= 10 ** 64) {
                      value /= 10 ** 64;
                      result += 64;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 32) {
                      value /= 10 ** 32;
                      result += 32;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 16) {
                      value /= 10 ** 16;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 8) {
                      value /= 10 ** 8;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 4) {
                      value /= 10 ** 4;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 2) {
                      value /= 10 ** 2;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >= 10 ** 1) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 10, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log10(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log10(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 10 ** result < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 256, rounded down, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           *
           * Adding one to the result gives the number of pairs of hex symbols needed to represent `value` as a hex string.
           */
          function log256(uint256 value) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              uint256 result = 0;
              unchecked {
                  if (value >> 128 > 0) {
                      value >>= 128;
                      result += 16;
                  }
                  if (value >> 64 > 0) {
                      value >>= 64;
                      result += 8;
                  }
                  if (value >> 32 > 0) {
                      value >>= 32;
                      result += 4;
                  }
                  if (value >> 16 > 0) {
                      value >>= 16;
                      result += 2;
                  }
                  if (value >> 8 > 0) {
                      result += 1;
                  }
              }
              return result;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Return the log in base 256, following the selected rounding direction, of a positive value.
           * Returns 0 if given 0.
           */
          function log256(uint256 value, Rounding rounding) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  uint256 result = log256(value);
                  return result + (rounding == Rounding.Up && 1 << (result << 3) < value ? 1 : 0);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      // OpenZeppelin Contracts (last updated v4.8.0) (utils/math/SignedMath.sol)
      pragma solidity ^0.8.0;
      /**
       * @dev Standard signed math utilities missing in the Solidity language.
       */
      library SignedMathUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @dev Returns the largest of two signed numbers.
           */
          function max(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              return a > b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the smallest of two signed numbers.
           */
          function min(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              return a < b ? a : b;
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the average of two signed numbers without overflow.
           * The result is rounded towards zero.
           */
          function average(int256 a, int256 b) internal pure returns (int256) {
              // Formula from the book "Hacker's Delight"
              int256 x = (a & b) + ((a ^ b) >> 1);
              return x + (int256(uint256(x) >> 255) & (a ^ b));
          }
          /**
           * @dev Returns the absolute unsigned value of a signed value.
           */
          function abs(int256 n) internal pure returns (uint256) {
              unchecked {
                  // must be unchecked in order to support `n = type(int256).min`
                  return uint256(n >= 0 ? n : -n);
              }
          }
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
      pragma solidity 0.8.16;
      interface IUpgradeable {
          /**
           * @notice Contract version number.
           *
           * @return uint256 The version number.
           */
          function version() external pure returns (uint256);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
      import "contracts-upgradeable/contracts/access/OwnableUpgradeable.sol";
      import "contracts-upgradeable/contracts/access/AccessControlUpgradeable.sol";
      abstract contract FixinAccessControlUpgradeable is AccessControlUpgradeable, OwnableUpgradeable {
          bytes32 internal constant MINTER_ROLE = keccak256("MINTER_ROLE");
          bytes32 internal constant BURNER_ROLE = keccak256("BURNER_ROLE");
          bytes32 internal constant GOVERNOR_ROLE = keccak256("GOVENOR_ROLE");
          function _setGovernor(address _governor) internal onlyOwner {
              _grantRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE, _governor);
          }
          function isGovernor() internal view returns (bool) {
              return hasRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE, msg.sender) || owner() == msg.sender;
          }
          function setGovernor(address governor) public virtual onlyOwner {
              _setGovernor(governor);
          }
      }// SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
      pragma solidity ^0.8.16;
      interface IStakingSBT {
         function mint(address staker, uint256 passId) external payable;
         function batchMint(address staker, uint256[] memory nfts) external payable;
         function underlyingToken(uint256 tokenId) external view returns(uint256);
         function burn(uint256 tokenId) external;
         function batchBurn(uint256[] memory nfts) external;
         function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) external view returns (address);
      }
      // SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-3.0-or-later
      pragma solidity 0.8.16;
      import "ERC721A/IERC721A.sol";
      import "../interfaces/IStakingSBT.sol";
      import "openzeppelin-contracts/contracts/token/ERC20/IERC20.sol";
      abstract contract SBTStorage {
          //  SBT ID -> NFT staking ID
          mapping (uint256 => uint256) public tokenMappings;
          // baseURI for the token metadata
          string public metadataURI;
          mapping(uint256 => string) internal tokenURIs;
      }
      //SPDX-License-Identifier: Unlicense
      pragma solidity ^0.8.9;
      import "../../../tokens/ERC721ABase.sol";
      import "../interfaces/IStakingSBT.sol";
      import "../storage/SBTStorage.sol";
      import "../../../interfaces/IUpgradeable.sol";
      import "openzeppelin-contracts/contracts/proxy/utils/UUPSUpgradeable.sol";
      contract StakingSBT is ERC721ABase, UUPSUpgradeable, SBTStorage, IStakingSBT, IUpgradeable {
          function _authorizeUpgrade(address) internal override onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) {}
          constructor() {
              _disableInitializers();
          }
          function initialize(address _owner, string memory _name, string memory _symbol, string memory _uri, string memory _contractUri) initializerERC721A initializer public {
              super._initialize(_name, _symbol, _uri, _contractUri, _owner);
              metadataURI = _uri;
          }
          function contractURI() public view returns (string memory) {
              return _contractURI;
          }
          function setTokenUri(uint256 _id, string memory _tokenURI) external  {
              require(isGovernor(), "User needs to have Governor role to change the token URI");
              tokenURIs[_id] = _tokenURI;
          }
          function updateBaseURI(string memory _newURI) external {
              require(isGovernor(), "User needs to have Governor role to change the token URI");
              _metadataURI = _newURI;
          }
          function tokenURI(uint256 tokenId) public view override(IERC721AUpgradeable, ERC721AUpgradeable) returns (string memory) {
              if (bytes(tokenURIs[tokenId]).length > 0) {
                  return tokenURIs[tokenId];
              }
              return _baseURI();
          }
          /**
           * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
           * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
           * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
           */
          function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return metadataURI;
          }
          function setURI(string memory uri_) external onlyOwner {
              metadataURI = uri_;
          }
          function setName(string memory name_) external onlyOwner {
          }
          function batchMint(address staker, uint256[] memory nfts) external payable onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) {
              uint256 startId = _nextTokenId();
              for (uint i=0; i< nfts.length; i++) {
                  tokenMappings[startId] = nfts[i];
                  startId += 1;         
              }
              _mint(staker, nfts.length);
          }
          function batchBurn(uint256[] memory nfts) external onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) { 
              for (uint i=0; i < nfts.length; i++) {
                  delete tokenMappings[nfts[i]];
                  _burn(nfts[i]);
              }
          }
          function mint(address staker, uint256 nftId) external payable onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) {
              uint256 nextId = _nextTokenId();
              tokenMappings[nextId] = nftId; 
              _mint(staker, 1);
          }
          function burn(uint256 tokenId) external onlyRole(GOVERNOR_ROLE) {
              _burn(tokenId);
          }
          function underlyingToken(uint256 tokenId) external view returns(uint256) {
              return tokenMappings[tokenId];
          }
          /// @dev The following functions are overrides required by Solidity.
          function _beforeTokenTransfers(
              address from,
              address to,
              uint256 tokenId,
              uint256 quantity
          ) internal override(ERC721AUpgradeable) {
             super._beforeTokenTransfers(from, to, tokenId, quantity);
             if (from != address(0) && to != address(0) && from != owner()) {
                revert("NFT token is not transferrable!");          
             }
          }
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(ERC721ABase) returns (bool) {
              return interfaceId == type(IStakingSBT).interfaceId || super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
          }
          function ownerOf(uint256 tokenId) public view override(IERC721AUpgradeable, ERC721AUpgradeable, IStakingSBT) returns (address) {
              return super.ownerOf(tokenId);
          }
          function version() external pure override returns (uint256) {
              return 5;
          }
      }// SPDX-License-Identifier: MIT
      pragma solidity ^0.8.16;
      import "ERC721A-Upgradeable/extensions/ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable.sol";
      import "../lib/fixins/FixinAccessControlUpgradeable.sol";
      import "contracts-upgradeable/contracts/security/ReentrancyGuardUpgradeable.sol";
      error WithdrawFailed();
      abstract contract ERC721ABase is Initializable, IERC721AUpgradeable, ERC721AQueryableUpgradeable, FixinAccessControlUpgradeable, ReentrancyGuardUpgradeable {
          //baseURI for the token metadata
          string public _metadataURI;
          string public _contractURI;
          event OwnerWithdrawn(uint256 amount);
          constructor() {
              _disableInitializers();
          }
          function _initialize(string memory _name, string memory _symbol, string memory baseUrl_, string memory _contractUri, address _owner) internal {
              _metadataURI = baseUrl_;
              _contractURI = _contractUri;
              __ERC721A_init(_name, _symbol);
              __ERC721AQueryable_init();
              _transferOwnership(_owner);
              __ReentrancyGuard_init();  
          }
          /**
           * @dev Base URI for computing {tokenURI}. If set, the resulting URI for each
           * token will be the concatenation of the `baseURI` and the `tokenId`. Empty
           * by default, it can be overridden in child contracts.
           */
          function _baseURI() internal view virtual override returns (string memory) {
              return _metadataURI;
          }
          function _startTokenId() internal view virtual override returns (uint256) {
              return 1;
          }
          function _checkOwnership(address owner, uint256[] memory tokens) internal view virtual returns (bool) {
              for (uint i = 0; i < tokens.length; ++i) {
                  if (ownerOf(tokens[i]) != owner) {
                      return false;
                  }
              }
              return true;
          }
          function supportsInterface(bytes4 interfaceId) public view virtual override(IERC721AUpgradeable, ERC721AUpgradeable, AccessControlUpgradeable) returns (bool) {
              return  interfaceId == 0x01ffc9a7 || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC165.
                  interfaceId == 0x80ac58cd || // ERC165 interface ID for ERC721.
                  interfaceId == 0x5b5e139f || 
                  super.supportsInterface(interfaceId);
          }
          function withdraw() external nonReentrant {
              uint256 balance = address(this).balance;
              address payable owner = payable(owner());
              (bool success, ) = owner.call{value: balance}("");
              if (!success) revert WithdrawFailed();
              emit OwnerWithdrawn(balance);
          }
      }